recog_memoized works on an rtx_insn *
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / config / frv / frv.c
blob13634ed820415a033388b3c708260697fb3a6cf8
1 /* Copyright (C) 1997-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 Contributed by Red Hat, Inc.
4 This file is part of GCC.
6 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
7 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
8 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
9 any later version.
11 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
12 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
13 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
14 GNU General Public License for more details.
16 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
17 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
18 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 #include "config.h"
21 #include "system.h"
22 #include "coretypes.h"
23 #include "tm.h"
24 #include "rtl.h"
25 #include "tree.h"
26 #include "varasm.h"
27 #include "stor-layout.h"
28 #include "stringpool.h"
29 #include "regs.h"
30 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
31 #include "insn-config.h"
32 #include "conditions.h"
33 #include "insn-flags.h"
34 #include "output.h"
35 #include "insn-attr.h"
36 #include "flags.h"
37 #include "recog.h"
38 #include "reload.h"
39 #include "expr.h"
40 #include "obstack.h"
41 #include "except.h"
42 #include "function.h"
43 #include "optabs.h"
44 #include "diagnostic-core.h"
45 #include "basic-block.h"
46 #include "tm_p.h"
47 #include "ggc.h"
48 #include "target.h"
49 #include "target-def.h"
50 #include "targhooks.h"
51 #include "langhooks.h"
52 #include "df.h"
53 #include "dumpfile.h"
54 #include "builtins.h"
56 #ifndef FRV_INLINE
57 #define FRV_INLINE inline
58 #endif
60 /* The maximum number of distinct NOP patterns. There are three:
61 nop, fnop and mnop. */
62 #define NUM_NOP_PATTERNS 3
64 /* Classification of instructions and units: integer, floating-point/media,
65 branch and control. */
66 enum frv_insn_group { GROUP_I, GROUP_FM, GROUP_B, GROUP_C, NUM_GROUPS };
68 /* The DFA names of the units, in packet order. */
69 static const char *const frv_unit_names[] =
71 "c",
72 "i0", "f0",
73 "i1", "f1",
74 "i2", "f2",
75 "i3", "f3",
76 "b0", "b1"
79 /* The classification of each unit in frv_unit_names[]. */
80 static const enum frv_insn_group frv_unit_groups[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names)] =
82 GROUP_C,
83 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
84 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
85 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
86 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
87 GROUP_B, GROUP_B
90 /* Return the DFA unit code associated with the Nth unit of integer
91 or floating-point group GROUP, */
92 #define NTH_UNIT(GROUP, N) frv_unit_codes[(GROUP) + (N) * 2 + 1]
94 /* Return the number of integer or floating-point unit UNIT
95 (1 for I1, 2 for F2, etc.). */
96 #define UNIT_NUMBER(UNIT) (((UNIT) - 1) / 2)
98 /* The DFA unit number for each unit in frv_unit_names[]. */
99 static int frv_unit_codes[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names)];
101 /* FRV_TYPE_TO_UNIT[T] is the last unit in frv_unit_names[] that can issue
102 an instruction of type T. The value is ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names) if
103 no instruction of type T has been seen. */
104 static unsigned int frv_type_to_unit[TYPE_UNKNOWN + 1];
106 /* An array of dummy nop INSNs, one for each type of nop that the
107 target supports. */
108 static GTY(()) rtx_insn *frv_nops[NUM_NOP_PATTERNS];
110 /* The number of nop instructions in frv_nops[]. */
111 static unsigned int frv_num_nops;
113 /* The type of access. FRV_IO_UNKNOWN means the access can be either
114 a read or a write. */
115 enum frv_io_type { FRV_IO_UNKNOWN, FRV_IO_READ, FRV_IO_WRITE };
117 /* Information about one __builtin_read or __builtin_write access, or
118 the combination of several such accesses. The most general value
119 is all-zeros (an unknown access to an unknown address). */
120 struct frv_io {
121 enum frv_io_type type;
123 /* The constant address being accessed, or zero if not known. */
124 HOST_WIDE_INT const_address;
126 /* The run-time address, as used in operand 0 of the membar pattern. */
127 rtx var_address;
130 /* Return true if instruction INSN should be packed with the following
131 instruction. */
132 #define PACKING_FLAG_P(INSN) (GET_MODE (INSN) == TImode)
134 /* Set the value of PACKING_FLAG_P(INSN). */
135 #define SET_PACKING_FLAG(INSN) PUT_MODE (INSN, TImode)
136 #define CLEAR_PACKING_FLAG(INSN) PUT_MODE (INSN, VOIDmode)
138 /* Loop with REG set to each hard register in rtx X. */
139 #define FOR_EACH_REGNO(REG, X) \
140 for (REG = REGNO (X); \
141 REG < REGNO (X) + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO (X), GET_MODE (X)); \
142 REG++)
144 /* This structure contains machine specific function data. */
145 struct GTY(()) machine_function
147 /* True if we have created an rtx that relies on the stack frame. */
148 int frame_needed;
150 /* True if this function contains at least one __builtin_{read,write}*. */
151 bool has_membar_p;
154 /* Temporary register allocation support structure. */
155 typedef struct frv_tmp_reg_struct
157 HARD_REG_SET regs; /* possible registers to allocate */
158 int next_reg[N_REG_CLASSES]; /* next register to allocate per class */
160 frv_tmp_reg_t;
162 /* Register state information for VLIW re-packing phase. */
163 #define REGSTATE_CC_MASK 0x07 /* Mask to isolate CCn for cond exec */
164 #define REGSTATE_MODIFIED 0x08 /* reg modified in current VLIW insn */
165 #define REGSTATE_IF_TRUE 0x10 /* reg modified in cond exec true */
166 #define REGSTATE_IF_FALSE 0x20 /* reg modified in cond exec false */
168 #define REGSTATE_IF_EITHER (REGSTATE_IF_TRUE | REGSTATE_IF_FALSE)
170 typedef unsigned char regstate_t;
172 /* Used in frv_frame_accessor_t to indicate the direction of a register-to-
173 memory move. */
174 enum frv_stack_op
176 FRV_LOAD,
177 FRV_STORE
180 /* Information required by frv_frame_access. */
181 typedef struct
183 /* This field is FRV_LOAD if registers are to be loaded from the stack and
184 FRV_STORE if they should be stored onto the stack. FRV_STORE implies
185 the move is being done by the prologue code while FRV_LOAD implies it
186 is being done by the epilogue. */
187 enum frv_stack_op op;
189 /* The base register to use when accessing the stack. This may be the
190 frame pointer, stack pointer, or a temporary. The choice of register
191 depends on which part of the frame is being accessed and how big the
192 frame is. */
193 rtx base;
195 /* The offset of BASE from the bottom of the current frame, in bytes. */
196 int base_offset;
197 } frv_frame_accessor_t;
199 /* Conditional execution support gathered together in one structure. */
200 typedef struct
202 /* Linked list of insns to add if the conditional execution conversion was
203 successful. Each link points to an EXPR_LIST which points to the pattern
204 of the insn to add, and the insn to be inserted before. */
205 rtx added_insns_list;
207 /* Identify which registers are safe to allocate for if conversions to
208 conditional execution. We keep the last allocated register in the
209 register classes between COND_EXEC statements. This will mean we allocate
210 different registers for each different COND_EXEC group if we can. This
211 might allow the scheduler to intermix two different COND_EXEC sections. */
212 frv_tmp_reg_t tmp_reg;
214 /* For nested IFs, identify which CC registers are used outside of setting
215 via a compare isnsn, and using via a check insn. This will allow us to
216 know if we can rewrite the register to use a different register that will
217 be paired with the CR register controlling the nested IF-THEN blocks. */
218 HARD_REG_SET nested_cc_ok_rewrite;
220 /* Temporary registers allocated to hold constants during conditional
221 execution. */
222 rtx scratch_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
224 /* Current number of temp registers available. */
225 int cur_scratch_regs;
227 /* Number of nested conditional execution blocks. */
228 int num_nested_cond_exec;
230 /* Map of insns that set up constants in scratch registers. */
231 bitmap scratch_insns_bitmap;
233 /* Conditional execution test register (CC0..CC7). */
234 rtx cr_reg;
236 /* Conditional execution compare register that is paired with cr_reg, so that
237 nested compares can be done. The csubcc and caddcc instructions don't
238 have enough bits to specify both a CC register to be set and a CR register
239 to do the test on, so the same bit number is used for both. Needless to
240 say, this is rather inconvenient for GCC. */
241 rtx nested_cc_reg;
243 /* Extra CR registers used for &&, ||. */
244 rtx extra_int_cr;
245 rtx extra_fp_cr;
247 /* Previous CR used in nested if, to make sure we are dealing with the same
248 nested if as the previous statement. */
249 rtx last_nested_if_cr;
251 frv_ifcvt_t;
253 static /* GTY(()) */ frv_ifcvt_t frv_ifcvt;
255 /* Map register number to smallest register class. */
256 enum reg_class regno_reg_class[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
258 /* Cached value of frv_stack_info. */
259 static frv_stack_t *frv_stack_cache = (frv_stack_t *)0;
261 /* Forward references */
263 static void frv_option_override (void);
264 static bool frv_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode, rtx, bool);
265 static int frv_default_flags_for_cpu (void);
266 static int frv_string_begins_with (const char *, const char *);
267 static FRV_INLINE bool frv_small_data_reloc_p (rtx, int);
268 static void frv_print_operand (FILE *, rtx, int);
269 static void frv_print_operand_address (FILE *, rtx);
270 static bool frv_print_operand_punct_valid_p (unsigned char code);
271 static void frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg
272 (FILE *, rtx);
273 static void frv_print_operand_memory_reference (FILE *, rtx, int);
274 static int frv_print_operand_jump_hint (rtx_insn *);
275 static const char *comparison_string (enum rtx_code, rtx);
276 static rtx frv_function_value (const_tree, const_tree,
277 bool);
278 static rtx frv_libcall_value (enum machine_mode,
279 const_rtx);
280 static FRV_INLINE int frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (int, int);
281 static rtx single_set_pattern (rtx);
282 static int frv_function_contains_far_jump (void);
283 static rtx frv_alloc_temp_reg (frv_tmp_reg_t *,
284 enum reg_class,
285 enum machine_mode,
286 int, int);
287 static rtx frv_frame_offset_rtx (int);
288 static rtx frv_frame_mem (enum machine_mode, rtx, int);
289 static rtx frv_dwarf_store (rtx, int);
290 static void frv_frame_insn (rtx, rtx);
291 static void frv_frame_access (frv_frame_accessor_t*,
292 rtx, int);
293 static void frv_frame_access_multi (frv_frame_accessor_t*,
294 frv_stack_t *, int);
295 static void frv_frame_access_standard_regs (enum frv_stack_op,
296 frv_stack_t *);
297 static struct machine_function *frv_init_machine_status (void);
298 static rtx frv_int_to_acc (enum insn_code, int, rtx);
299 static enum machine_mode frv_matching_accg_mode (enum machine_mode);
300 static rtx frv_read_argument (tree, unsigned int);
301 static rtx frv_read_iacc_argument (enum machine_mode, tree, unsigned int);
302 static int frv_check_constant_argument (enum insn_code, int, rtx);
303 static rtx frv_legitimize_target (enum insn_code, rtx);
304 static rtx frv_legitimize_argument (enum insn_code, int, rtx);
305 static rtx frv_legitimize_tls_address (rtx, enum tls_model);
306 static rtx frv_legitimize_address (rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode);
307 static rtx frv_expand_set_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
308 static rtx frv_expand_unop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
309 static rtx frv_expand_binop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
310 static rtx frv_expand_cut_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
311 static rtx frv_expand_binopimm_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
312 static rtx frv_expand_voidbinop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
313 static rtx frv_expand_int_void2arg (enum insn_code, tree);
314 static rtx frv_expand_prefetches (enum insn_code, tree);
315 static rtx frv_expand_voidtriop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
316 static rtx frv_expand_voidaccop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
317 static rtx frv_expand_mclracc_builtin (tree);
318 static rtx frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
319 static rtx frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
320 static rtx frv_expand_noargs_builtin (enum insn_code);
321 static void frv_split_iacc_move (rtx, rtx);
322 static rtx frv_emit_comparison (enum rtx_code, rtx, rtx);
323 static int frv_clear_registers_used (rtx *, void *);
324 static void frv_ifcvt_add_insn (rtx, rtx, int);
325 static rtx frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx);
326 static rtx frv_ifcvt_load_value (rtx, rtx);
327 static int frv_acc_group_1 (rtx *, void *);
328 static unsigned int frv_insn_unit (rtx);
329 static bool frv_issues_to_branch_unit_p (rtx);
330 static int frv_cond_flags (rtx);
331 static bool frv_regstate_conflict_p (regstate_t, regstate_t);
332 static int frv_registers_conflict_p_1 (rtx *, void *);
333 static bool frv_registers_conflict_p (rtx);
334 static void frv_registers_update_1 (rtx, const_rtx, void *);
335 static void frv_registers_update (rtx);
336 static void frv_start_packet (void);
337 static void frv_start_packet_block (void);
338 static void frv_finish_packet (void (*) (void));
339 static bool frv_pack_insn_p (rtx);
340 static void frv_add_insn_to_packet (rtx_insn *);
341 static void frv_insert_nop_in_packet (rtx_insn *);
342 static bool frv_for_each_packet (void (*) (void));
343 static bool frv_sort_insn_group_1 (enum frv_insn_group,
344 unsigned int, unsigned int,
345 unsigned int, unsigned int,
346 state_t);
347 static int frv_compare_insns (const void *, const void *);
348 static void frv_sort_insn_group (enum frv_insn_group);
349 static void frv_reorder_packet (void);
350 static void frv_fill_unused_units (enum frv_insn_group);
351 static void frv_align_label (void);
352 static void frv_reorg_packet (void);
353 static void frv_register_nop (rtx);
354 static void frv_reorg (void);
355 static void frv_pack_insns (void);
356 static void frv_function_prologue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
357 static void frv_function_epilogue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
358 static bool frv_assemble_integer (rtx, unsigned, int);
359 static void frv_init_builtins (void);
360 static rtx frv_expand_builtin (tree, rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode, int);
361 static void frv_init_libfuncs (void);
362 static bool frv_in_small_data_p (const_tree);
363 static void frv_asm_output_mi_thunk
364 (FILE *, tree, HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT, tree);
365 static void frv_setup_incoming_varargs (cumulative_args_t,
366 enum machine_mode,
367 tree, int *, int);
368 static rtx frv_expand_builtin_saveregs (void);
369 static void frv_expand_builtin_va_start (tree, rtx);
370 static bool frv_rtx_costs (rtx, int, int, int, int*,
371 bool);
372 static int frv_register_move_cost (enum machine_mode,
373 reg_class_t, reg_class_t);
374 static int frv_memory_move_cost (enum machine_mode,
375 reg_class_t, bool);
376 static void frv_asm_out_constructor (rtx, int);
377 static void frv_asm_out_destructor (rtx, int);
378 static bool frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (rtx);
379 static bool frv_legitimate_constant_p (enum machine_mode, rtx);
380 static bool frv_cannot_force_const_mem (enum machine_mode, rtx);
381 static const char *unspec_got_name (int);
382 static void frv_output_const_unspec (FILE *,
383 const struct frv_unspec *);
384 static bool frv_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree, tree);
385 static rtx frv_struct_value_rtx (tree, int);
386 static bool frv_must_pass_in_stack (enum machine_mode mode, const_tree type);
387 static int frv_arg_partial_bytes (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
388 tree, bool);
389 static rtx frv_function_arg (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
390 const_tree, bool);
391 static rtx frv_function_incoming_arg (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
392 const_tree, bool);
393 static void frv_function_arg_advance (cumulative_args_t, enum machine_mode,
394 const_tree, bool);
395 static unsigned int frv_function_arg_boundary (enum machine_mode,
396 const_tree);
397 static void frv_output_dwarf_dtprel (FILE *, int, rtx)
398 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
399 static reg_class_t frv_secondary_reload (bool, rtx, reg_class_t,
400 enum machine_mode,
401 secondary_reload_info *);
402 static bool frv_frame_pointer_required (void);
403 static bool frv_can_eliminate (const int, const int);
404 static void frv_conditional_register_usage (void);
405 static void frv_trampoline_init (rtx, tree, rtx);
406 static bool frv_class_likely_spilled_p (reg_class_t);
408 /* Initialize the GCC target structure. */
409 #undef TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND
410 #define TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND frv_print_operand
411 #undef TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS
412 #define TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS frv_print_operand_address
413 #undef TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P
414 #define TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P frv_print_operand_punct_valid_p
415 #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
416 #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE frv_function_prologue
417 #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
418 #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE frv_function_epilogue
419 #undef TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
420 #define TARGET_ASM_INTEGER frv_assemble_integer
421 #undef TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
422 #define TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE frv_option_override
423 #undef TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
424 #define TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS frv_init_builtins
425 #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
426 #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN frv_expand_builtin
427 #undef TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
428 #define TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS frv_init_libfuncs
429 #undef TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
430 #define TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P frv_in_small_data_p
431 #undef TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
432 #define TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST frv_register_move_cost
433 #undef TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
434 #define TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST frv_memory_move_cost
435 #undef TARGET_RTX_COSTS
436 #define TARGET_RTX_COSTS frv_rtx_costs
437 #undef TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
438 #define TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR frv_asm_out_constructor
439 #undef TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
440 #define TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR frv_asm_out_destructor
442 #undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
443 #define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK frv_asm_output_mi_thunk
444 #undef TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
445 #define TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK default_can_output_mi_thunk_no_vcall
447 #undef TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
448 #define TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE frv_issue_rate
450 #undef TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
451 #define TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS frv_legitimize_address
453 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
454 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL frv_function_ok_for_sibcall
455 #undef TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
456 #define TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P frv_legitimate_constant_p
457 #undef TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
458 #define TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM frv_cannot_force_const_mem
460 #undef TARGET_HAVE_TLS
461 #define TARGET_HAVE_TLS HAVE_AS_TLS
463 #undef TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
464 #define TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX frv_struct_value_rtx
465 #undef TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
466 #define TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK frv_must_pass_in_stack
467 #undef TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
468 #define TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE hook_pass_by_reference_must_pass_in_stack
469 #undef TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
470 #define TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES frv_arg_partial_bytes
471 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG
472 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG frv_function_arg
473 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
474 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG frv_function_incoming_arg
475 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
476 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE frv_function_arg_advance
477 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
478 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY frv_function_arg_boundary
480 #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
481 #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS frv_expand_builtin_saveregs
482 #undef TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
483 #define TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS frv_setup_incoming_varargs
484 #undef TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
485 #define TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG frv_reorg
487 #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_VA_START
488 #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_VA_START frv_expand_builtin_va_start
490 #if HAVE_AS_TLS
491 #undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
492 #define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL frv_output_dwarf_dtprel
493 #endif
495 #undef TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
496 #define TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P frv_class_likely_spilled_p
498 #undef TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
499 #define TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD frv_secondary_reload
501 #undef TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
502 #define TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P frv_legitimate_address_p
504 #undef TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
505 #define TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED frv_frame_pointer_required
507 #undef TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
508 #define TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE frv_can_eliminate
510 #undef TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
511 #define TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE frv_conditional_register_usage
513 #undef TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
514 #define TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT frv_trampoline_init
516 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
517 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE frv_function_value
518 #undef TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
519 #define TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE frv_libcall_value
521 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
523 #define FRV_SYMBOL_REF_TLS_P(RTX) \
524 (GET_CODE (RTX) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (RTX) != 0)
527 /* Any function call that satisfies the machine-independent
528 requirements is eligible on FR-V. */
530 static bool
531 frv_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree decl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
532 tree exp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
534 return true;
537 /* Return true if SYMBOL is a small data symbol and relocation RELOC
538 can be used to access it directly in a load or store. */
540 static FRV_INLINE bool
541 frv_small_data_reloc_p (rtx symbol, int reloc)
543 return (GET_CODE (symbol) == SYMBOL_REF
544 && SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (symbol)
545 && (!TARGET_FDPIC || flag_pic == 1)
546 && (reloc == R_FRV_GOTOFF12 || reloc == R_FRV_GPREL12));
549 /* Return true if X is a valid relocation unspec. If it is, fill in UNSPEC
550 appropriately. */
552 bool
553 frv_const_unspec_p (rtx x, struct frv_unspec *unspec)
555 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST)
557 unspec->offset = 0;
558 x = XEXP (x, 0);
559 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
561 unspec->offset += INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
562 x = XEXP (x, 0);
564 if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC && XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_GOT)
566 unspec->symbol = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
567 unspec->reloc = INTVAL (XVECEXP (x, 0, 1));
569 if (unspec->offset == 0)
570 return true;
572 if (frv_small_data_reloc_p (unspec->symbol, unspec->reloc)
573 && unspec->offset > 0
574 && unspec->offset < g_switch_value)
575 return true;
578 return false;
581 /* Decide whether we can force certain constants to memory. If we
582 decide we can't, the caller should be able to cope with it in
583 another way.
585 We never allow constants to be forced into memory for TARGET_FDPIC.
586 This is necessary for several reasons:
588 1. Since frv_legitimate_constant_p rejects constant pool addresses, the
589 target-independent code will try to force them into the constant
590 pool, thus leading to infinite recursion.
592 2. We can never introduce new constant pool references during reload.
593 Any such reference would require use of the pseudo FDPIC register.
595 3. We can't represent a constant added to a function pointer (which is
596 not the same as a pointer to a function+constant).
598 4. In many cases, it's more efficient to calculate the constant in-line. */
600 static bool
601 frv_cannot_force_const_mem (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
602 rtx x ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
604 return TARGET_FDPIC;
607 static int
608 frv_default_flags_for_cpu (void)
610 switch (frv_cpu_type)
612 case FRV_CPU_GENERIC:
613 return MASK_DEFAULT_FRV;
615 case FRV_CPU_FR550:
616 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR550;
618 case FRV_CPU_FR500:
619 case FRV_CPU_TOMCAT:
620 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR500;
622 case FRV_CPU_FR450:
623 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR450;
625 case FRV_CPU_FR405:
626 case FRV_CPU_FR400:
627 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR400;
629 case FRV_CPU_FR300:
630 case FRV_CPU_SIMPLE:
631 return MASK_DEFAULT_SIMPLE;
633 default:
634 gcc_unreachable ();
638 /* Implement TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE. */
640 static void
641 frv_option_override (void)
643 int regno;
644 unsigned int i;
646 target_flags |= (frv_default_flags_for_cpu () & ~target_flags_explicit);
648 /* -mlibrary-pic sets -fPIC and -G0 and also suppresses warnings from the
649 linker about linking pic and non-pic code. */
650 if (TARGET_LIBPIC)
652 if (!flag_pic) /* -fPIC */
653 flag_pic = 2;
655 if (!global_options_set.x_g_switch_value) /* -G0 */
657 g_switch_value = 0;
661 /* A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard
662 register REGNO. In general there is more than one such class;
663 choose a class which is "minimal", meaning that no smaller class
664 also contains the register. */
666 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++)
668 enum reg_class rclass;
670 if (GPR_P (regno))
672 int gpr_reg = regno - GPR_FIRST;
674 if (gpr_reg == GR8_REG)
675 rclass = GR8_REGS;
677 else if (gpr_reg == GR9_REG)
678 rclass = GR9_REGS;
680 else if (gpr_reg == GR14_REG)
681 rclass = FDPIC_FPTR_REGS;
683 else if (gpr_reg == FDPIC_REGNO)
684 rclass = FDPIC_REGS;
686 else if ((gpr_reg & 3) == 0)
687 rclass = QUAD_REGS;
689 else if ((gpr_reg & 1) == 0)
690 rclass = EVEN_REGS;
692 else
693 rclass = GPR_REGS;
696 else if (FPR_P (regno))
698 int fpr_reg = regno - GPR_FIRST;
699 if ((fpr_reg & 3) == 0)
700 rclass = QUAD_FPR_REGS;
702 else if ((fpr_reg & 1) == 0)
703 rclass = FEVEN_REGS;
705 else
706 rclass = FPR_REGS;
709 else if (regno == LR_REGNO)
710 rclass = LR_REG;
712 else if (regno == LCR_REGNO)
713 rclass = LCR_REG;
715 else if (ICC_P (regno))
716 rclass = ICC_REGS;
718 else if (FCC_P (regno))
719 rclass = FCC_REGS;
721 else if (ICR_P (regno))
722 rclass = ICR_REGS;
724 else if (FCR_P (regno))
725 rclass = FCR_REGS;
727 else if (ACC_P (regno))
729 int r = regno - ACC_FIRST;
730 if ((r & 3) == 0)
731 rclass = QUAD_ACC_REGS;
732 else if ((r & 1) == 0)
733 rclass = EVEN_ACC_REGS;
734 else
735 rclass = ACC_REGS;
738 else if (ACCG_P (regno))
739 rclass = ACCG_REGS;
741 else
742 rclass = NO_REGS;
744 regno_reg_class[regno] = rclass;
747 /* Check for small data option */
748 if (!global_options_set.x_g_switch_value && !TARGET_LIBPIC)
749 g_switch_value = SDATA_DEFAULT_SIZE;
751 /* There is no single unaligned SI op for PIC code. Sometimes we
752 need to use ".4byte" and sometimes we need to use ".picptr".
753 See frv_assemble_integer for details. */
754 if (flag_pic || TARGET_FDPIC)
755 targetm.asm_out.unaligned_op.si = 0;
757 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_LINKED_FP) == 0)
758 target_flags |= MASK_LINKED_FP;
760 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_OPTIMIZE_MEMBAR) == 0)
761 target_flags |= MASK_OPTIMIZE_MEMBAR;
763 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names); i++)
764 frv_unit_codes[i] = get_cpu_unit_code (frv_unit_names[i]);
766 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_type_to_unit); i++)
767 frv_type_to_unit[i] = ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes);
769 init_machine_status = frv_init_machine_status;
773 /* Return true if NAME (a STRING_CST node) begins with PREFIX. */
775 static int
776 frv_string_begins_with (const char *name, const char *prefix)
778 const int prefix_len = strlen (prefix);
780 /* Remember: NAME's length includes the null terminator. */
781 return (strncmp (name, prefix, prefix_len) == 0);
784 /* Implement TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE. */
786 static void
787 frv_conditional_register_usage (void)
789 int i;
791 for (i = GPR_FIRST + NUM_GPRS; i <= GPR_LAST; i++)
792 fixed_regs[i] = call_used_regs[i] = 1;
794 for (i = FPR_FIRST + NUM_FPRS; i <= FPR_LAST; i++)
795 fixed_regs[i] = call_used_regs[i] = 1;
797 /* Reserve the registers used for conditional execution. At present, we need
798 1 ICC and 1 ICR register. */
799 fixed_regs[ICC_TEMP] = call_used_regs[ICC_TEMP] = 1;
800 fixed_regs[ICR_TEMP] = call_used_regs[ICR_TEMP] = 1;
802 if (TARGET_FIXED_CC)
804 fixed_regs[ICC_FIRST] = call_used_regs[ICC_FIRST] = 1;
805 fixed_regs[FCC_FIRST] = call_used_regs[FCC_FIRST] = 1;
806 fixed_regs[ICR_FIRST] = call_used_regs[ICR_FIRST] = 1;
807 fixed_regs[FCR_FIRST] = call_used_regs[FCR_FIRST] = 1;
810 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
811 fixed_regs[GPR_FIRST + 16] = fixed_regs[GPR_FIRST + 17] =
812 call_used_regs[GPR_FIRST + 16] = call_used_regs[GPR_FIRST + 17] = 0;
814 #if 0
815 /* If -fpic, SDA_BASE_REG is the PIC register. */
816 if (g_switch_value == 0 && !flag_pic)
817 fixed_regs[SDA_BASE_REG] = call_used_regs[SDA_BASE_REG] = 0;
819 if (!flag_pic)
820 fixed_regs[PIC_REGNO] = call_used_regs[PIC_REGNO] = 0;
821 #endif
826 * Compute the stack frame layout
828 * Register setup:
829 * +---------------+-----------------------+-----------------------+
830 * |Register |type |caller-save/callee-save|
831 * +---------------+-----------------------+-----------------------+
832 * |GR0 |Zero register | - |
833 * |GR1 |Stack pointer(SP) | - |
834 * |GR2 |Frame pointer(FP) | - |
835 * |GR3 |Hidden parameter | caller save |
836 * |GR4-GR7 | - | caller save |
837 * |GR8-GR13 |Argument register | caller save |
838 * |GR14-GR15 | - | caller save |
839 * |GR16-GR31 | - | callee save |
840 * |GR32-GR47 | - | caller save |
841 * |GR48-GR63 | - | callee save |
842 * |FR0-FR15 | - | caller save |
843 * |FR16-FR31 | - | callee save |
844 * |FR32-FR47 | - | caller save |
845 * |FR48-FR63 | - | callee save |
846 * +---------------+-----------------------+-----------------------+
848 * Stack frame setup:
849 * Low
850 * SP-> |-----------------------------------|
851 * | Argument area |
852 * |-----------------------------------|
853 * | Register save area |
854 * |-----------------------------------|
855 * | Local variable save area |
856 * FP-> |-----------------------------------|
857 * | Old FP |
858 * |-----------------------------------|
859 * | Hidden parameter save area |
860 * |-----------------------------------|
861 * | Return address(LR) storage area |
862 * |-----------------------------------|
863 * | Padding for alignment |
864 * |-----------------------------------|
865 * | Register argument area |
866 * OLD SP-> |-----------------------------------|
867 * | Parameter area |
868 * |-----------------------------------|
869 * High
871 * Argument area/Parameter area:
873 * When a function is called, this area is used for argument transfer. When
874 * the argument is set up by the caller function, this area is referred to as
875 * the argument area. When the argument is referenced by the callee function,
876 * this area is referred to as the parameter area. The area is allocated when
877 * all arguments cannot be placed on the argument register at the time of
878 * argument transfer.
880 * Register save area:
882 * This is a register save area that must be guaranteed for the caller
883 * function. This area is not secured when the register save operation is not
884 * needed.
886 * Local variable save area:
888 * This is the area for local variables and temporary variables.
890 * Old FP:
892 * This area stores the FP value of the caller function.
894 * Hidden parameter save area:
896 * This area stores the start address of the return value storage
897 * area for a struct/union return function.
898 * When a struct/union is used as the return value, the caller
899 * function stores the return value storage area start address in
900 * register GR3 and passes it to the caller function.
901 * The callee function interprets the address stored in the GR3
902 * as the return value storage area start address.
903 * When register GR3 needs to be saved into memory, the callee
904 * function saves it in the hidden parameter save area. This
905 * area is not secured when the save operation is not needed.
907 * Return address(LR) storage area:
909 * This area saves the LR. The LR stores the address of a return to the caller
910 * function for the purpose of function calling.
912 * Argument register area:
914 * This area saves the argument register. This area is not secured when the
915 * save operation is not needed.
917 * Argument:
919 * Arguments, the count of which equals the count of argument registers (6
920 * words), are positioned in registers GR8 to GR13 and delivered to the callee
921 * function. When a struct/union return function is called, the return value
922 * area address is stored in register GR3. Arguments not placed in the
923 * argument registers will be stored in the stack argument area for transfer
924 * purposes. When an 8-byte type argument is to be delivered using registers,
925 * it is divided into two and placed in two registers for transfer. When
926 * argument registers must be saved to memory, the callee function secures an
927 * argument register save area in the stack. In this case, a continuous
928 * argument register save area must be established in the parameter area. The
929 * argument register save area must be allocated as needed to cover the size of
930 * the argument register to be saved. If the function has a variable count of
931 * arguments, it saves all argument registers in the argument register save
932 * area.
934 * Argument Extension Format:
936 * When an argument is to be stored in the stack, its type is converted to an
937 * extended type in accordance with the individual argument type. The argument
938 * is freed by the caller function after the return from the callee function is
939 * made.
941 * +-----------------------+---------------+------------------------+
942 * | Argument Type |Extended Type |Stack Storage Size(byte)|
943 * +-----------------------+---------------+------------------------+
944 * |char |int | 4 |
945 * |signed char |int | 4 |
946 * |unsigned char |int | 4 |
947 * |[signed] short int |int | 4 |
948 * |unsigned short int |int | 4 |
949 * |[signed] int |No extension | 4 |
950 * |unsigned int |No extension | 4 |
951 * |[signed] long int |No extension | 4 |
952 * |unsigned long int |No extension | 4 |
953 * |[signed] long long int |No extension | 8 |
954 * |unsigned long long int |No extension | 8 |
955 * |float |double | 8 |
956 * |double |No extension | 8 |
957 * |long double |No extension | 8 |
958 * |pointer |No extension | 4 |
959 * |struct/union |- | 4 (*1) |
960 * +-----------------------+---------------+------------------------+
962 * When a struct/union is to be delivered as an argument, the caller copies it
963 * to the local variable area and delivers the address of that area.
965 * Return Value:
967 * +-------------------------------+----------------------+
968 * |Return Value Type |Return Value Interface|
969 * +-------------------------------+----------------------+
970 * |void |None |
971 * |[signed|unsigned] char |GR8 |
972 * |[signed|unsigned] short int |GR8 |
973 * |[signed|unsigned] int |GR8 |
974 * |[signed|unsigned] long int |GR8 |
975 * |pointer |GR8 |
976 * |[signed|unsigned] long long int|GR8 & GR9 |
977 * |float |GR8 |
978 * |double |GR8 & GR9 |
979 * |long double |GR8 & GR9 |
980 * |struct/union |(*1) |
981 * +-------------------------------+----------------------+
983 * When a struct/union is used as the return value, the caller function stores
984 * the start address of the return value storage area into GR3 and then passes
985 * it to the callee function. The callee function interprets GR3 as the start
986 * address of the return value storage area. When this address needs to be
987 * saved in memory, the callee function secures the hidden parameter save area
988 * and saves the address in that area.
991 frv_stack_t *
992 frv_stack_info (void)
994 static frv_stack_t info, zero_info;
995 frv_stack_t *info_ptr = &info;
996 tree fndecl = current_function_decl;
997 int varargs_p = 0;
998 tree cur_arg;
999 tree next_arg;
1000 int range;
1001 int alignment;
1002 int offset;
1004 /* If we've already calculated the values and reload is complete,
1005 just return now. */
1006 if (frv_stack_cache)
1007 return frv_stack_cache;
1009 /* Zero all fields. */
1010 info = zero_info;
1012 /* Set up the register range information. */
1013 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].name = "gpr";
1014 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].first = LAST_ARG_REGNUM + 1;
1015 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].last = GPR_LAST;
1016 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].dword_p = TRUE;
1018 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].name = "fpr";
1019 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].first = FPR_FIRST;
1020 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].last = FPR_LAST;
1021 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].dword_p = TRUE;
1023 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].name = "lr";
1024 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].first = LR_REGNO;
1025 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].last = LR_REGNO;
1026 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].special_p = 1;
1028 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].name = "cc";
1029 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].first = CC_FIRST;
1030 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].last = CC_LAST;
1031 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].field_p = TRUE;
1033 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LCR].name = "lcr";
1034 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LCR].first = LCR_REGNO;
1035 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LCR].last = LCR_REGNO;
1037 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].name = "stdarg";
1038 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].first = FIRST_ARG_REGNUM;
1039 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].last = LAST_ARG_REGNUM;
1040 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].dword_p = 1;
1041 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].special_p = 1;
1043 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].name = "struct";
1044 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].first = FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM;
1045 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].last = FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM;
1046 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].special_p = 1;
1048 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].name = "fp";
1049 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].first = FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1050 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].last = FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1051 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].special_p = 1;
1053 /* Determine if this is a stdarg function. If so, allocate space to store
1054 the 6 arguments. */
1055 if (cfun->stdarg)
1056 varargs_p = 1;
1058 else
1060 /* Find the last argument, and see if it is __builtin_va_alist. */
1061 for (cur_arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl); cur_arg != (tree)0; cur_arg = next_arg)
1063 next_arg = DECL_CHAIN (cur_arg);
1064 if (next_arg == (tree)0)
1066 if (DECL_NAME (cur_arg)
1067 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (cur_arg)), "__builtin_va_alist"))
1068 varargs_p = 1;
1070 break;
1075 /* Iterate over all of the register ranges. */
1076 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1078 frv_stack_regs_t *reg_ptr = &(info_ptr->regs[range]);
1079 int first = reg_ptr->first;
1080 int last = reg_ptr->last;
1081 int size_1word = 0;
1082 int size_2words = 0;
1083 int regno;
1085 /* Calculate which registers need to be saved & save area size. */
1086 switch (range)
1088 default:
1089 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1091 if ((df_regs_ever_live_p (regno) && !call_used_regs[regno])
1092 || (crtl->calls_eh_return
1093 && (regno >= FIRST_EH_REGNUM && regno <= LAST_EH_REGNUM))
1094 || (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic
1095 && crtl->uses_pic_offset_table && regno == PIC_REGNO))
1097 info_ptr->save_p[regno] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1098 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1101 break;
1103 /* Calculate whether we need to create a frame after everything else
1104 has been processed. */
1105 case STACK_REGS_FP:
1106 break;
1108 case STACK_REGS_LR:
1109 if (df_regs_ever_live_p (LR_REGNO)
1110 || profile_flag
1111 /* This is set for __builtin_return_address, etc. */
1112 || cfun->machine->frame_needed
1113 || (TARGET_LINKED_FP && frame_pointer_needed)
1114 || (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic
1115 && crtl->uses_pic_offset_table))
1117 info_ptr->save_p[LR_REGNO] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1118 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1120 break;
1122 case STACK_REGS_STDARG:
1123 if (varargs_p)
1125 /* If this is a stdarg function with a non varardic
1126 argument split between registers and the stack,
1127 adjust the saved registers downward. */
1128 last -= (ADDR_ALIGN (crtl->args.pretend_args_size, UNITS_PER_WORD)
1129 / UNITS_PER_WORD);
1131 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1133 info_ptr->save_p[regno] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1134 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1137 info_ptr->stdarg_size = size_1word;
1139 break;
1141 case STACK_REGS_STRUCT:
1142 if (cfun->returns_struct)
1144 info_ptr->save_p[FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1145 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1147 break;
1151 if (size_1word)
1153 /* If this is a field, it only takes one word. */
1154 if (reg_ptr->field_p)
1155 size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1157 /* Determine which register pairs can be saved together. */
1158 else if (reg_ptr->dword_p && TARGET_DWORD)
1160 for (regno = first; regno < last; regno += 2)
1162 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] && info_ptr->save_p[regno+1])
1164 size_2words += 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1165 size_1word -= 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1166 info_ptr->save_p[regno] = REG_SAVE_2WORDS;
1167 info_ptr->save_p[regno+1] = REG_SAVE_NO_SAVE;
1172 reg_ptr->size_1word = size_1word;
1173 reg_ptr->size_2words = size_2words;
1175 if (! reg_ptr->special_p)
1177 info_ptr->regs_size_1word += size_1word;
1178 info_ptr->regs_size_2words += size_2words;
1183 /* Set up the sizes of each each field in the frame body, making the sizes
1184 of each be divisible by the size of a dword if dword operations might
1185 be used, or the size of a word otherwise. */
1186 alignment = (TARGET_DWORD? 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD : UNITS_PER_WORD);
1188 info_ptr->parameter_size = ADDR_ALIGN (crtl->outgoing_args_size, alignment);
1189 info_ptr->regs_size = ADDR_ALIGN (info_ptr->regs_size_2words
1190 + info_ptr->regs_size_1word,
1191 alignment);
1192 info_ptr->vars_size = ADDR_ALIGN (get_frame_size (), alignment);
1194 info_ptr->pretend_size = crtl->args.pretend_args_size;
1196 /* Work out the size of the frame, excluding the header. Both the frame
1197 body and register parameter area will be dword-aligned. */
1198 info_ptr->total_size
1199 = (ADDR_ALIGN (info_ptr->parameter_size
1200 + info_ptr->regs_size
1201 + info_ptr->vars_size,
1202 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD)
1203 + ADDR_ALIGN (info_ptr->pretend_size
1204 + info_ptr->stdarg_size,
1205 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD));
1207 /* See if we need to create a frame at all, if so add header area. */
1208 if (info_ptr->total_size > 0
1209 || frame_pointer_needed
1210 || info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].size_1word > 0
1211 || info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].size_1word > 0)
1213 offset = info_ptr->parameter_size;
1214 info_ptr->header_size = 4 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1215 info_ptr->total_size += 4 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1217 /* Calculate the offsets to save normal register pairs. */
1218 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1220 frv_stack_regs_t *reg_ptr = &(info_ptr->regs[range]);
1221 if (! reg_ptr->special_p)
1223 int first = reg_ptr->first;
1224 int last = reg_ptr->last;
1225 int regno;
1227 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1228 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS
1229 && regno != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1230 && (regno < FIRST_ARG_REGNUM
1231 || regno > LAST_ARG_REGNUM))
1233 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1234 offset += 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1239 /* Calculate the offsets to save normal single registers. */
1240 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1242 frv_stack_regs_t *reg_ptr = &(info_ptr->regs[range]);
1243 if (! reg_ptr->special_p)
1245 int first = reg_ptr->first;
1246 int last = reg_ptr->last;
1247 int regno;
1249 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1250 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_1WORD
1251 && regno != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1252 && (regno < FIRST_ARG_REGNUM
1253 || regno > LAST_ARG_REGNUM))
1255 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1256 offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1261 /* Calculate the offset to save the local variables at. */
1262 offset = ADDR_ALIGN (offset, alignment);
1263 if (info_ptr->vars_size)
1265 info_ptr->vars_offset = offset;
1266 offset += info_ptr->vars_size;
1269 /* Align header to a dword-boundary. */
1270 offset = ADDR_ALIGN (offset, 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD);
1272 /* Calculate the offsets in the fixed frame. */
1273 info_ptr->save_p[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1274 info_ptr->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM] = offset;
1275 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1277 info_ptr->save_p[LR_REGNO] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1278 info_ptr->reg_offset[LR_REGNO] = offset + 2*UNITS_PER_WORD;
1279 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1281 if (cfun->returns_struct)
1283 info_ptr->save_p[FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1284 info_ptr->reg_offset[FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM] = offset + UNITS_PER_WORD;
1285 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1288 /* Calculate the offsets to store the arguments passed in registers
1289 for stdarg functions. The register pairs are first and the single
1290 register if any is last. The register save area starts on a
1291 dword-boundary. */
1292 if (info_ptr->stdarg_size)
1294 int first = info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].first;
1295 int last = info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].last;
1296 int regno;
1298 /* Skip the header. */
1299 offset += 4 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1300 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1302 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS)
1304 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1305 offset += 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1307 else if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_1WORD)
1309 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1310 offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1316 if (reload_completed)
1317 frv_stack_cache = info_ptr;
1319 return info_ptr;
1323 /* Print the information about the frv stack offsets, etc. when debugging. */
1325 void
1326 frv_debug_stack (frv_stack_t *info)
1328 int range;
1330 if (!info)
1331 info = frv_stack_info ();
1333 fprintf (stderr, "\nStack information for function %s:\n",
1334 ((current_function_decl && DECL_NAME (current_function_decl))
1335 ? IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (current_function_decl))
1336 : "<unknown>"));
1338 fprintf (stderr, "\ttotal_size\t= %6d\n", info->total_size);
1339 fprintf (stderr, "\tvars_size\t= %6d\n", info->vars_size);
1340 fprintf (stderr, "\tparam_size\t= %6d\n", info->parameter_size);
1341 fprintf (stderr, "\tregs_size\t= %6d, 1w = %3d, 2w = %3d\n",
1342 info->regs_size, info->regs_size_1word, info->regs_size_2words);
1344 fprintf (stderr, "\theader_size\t= %6d\n", info->header_size);
1345 fprintf (stderr, "\tpretend_size\t= %6d\n", info->pretend_size);
1346 fprintf (stderr, "\tvars_offset\t= %6d\n", info->vars_offset);
1347 fprintf (stderr, "\tregs_offset\t= %6d\n", info->regs_offset);
1349 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1351 frv_stack_regs_t *regs = &(info->regs[range]);
1352 if ((regs->size_1word + regs->size_2words) > 0)
1354 int first = regs->first;
1355 int last = regs->last;
1356 int regno;
1358 fprintf (stderr, "\t%s\tsize\t= %6d, 1w = %3d, 2w = %3d, save =",
1359 regs->name, regs->size_1word + regs->size_2words,
1360 regs->size_1word, regs->size_2words);
1362 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1364 if (info->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_1WORD)
1365 fprintf (stderr, " %s (%d)", reg_names[regno],
1366 info->reg_offset[regno]);
1368 else if (info->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS)
1369 fprintf (stderr, " %s-%s (%d)", reg_names[regno],
1370 reg_names[regno+1], info->reg_offset[regno]);
1373 fputc ('\n', stderr);
1377 fflush (stderr);
1383 /* Used during final to control the packing of insns. The value is
1384 1 if the current instruction should be packed with the next one,
1385 0 if it shouldn't or -1 if packing is disabled altogether. */
1387 static int frv_insn_packing_flag;
1389 /* True if the current function contains a far jump. */
1391 static int
1392 frv_function_contains_far_jump (void)
1394 rtx_insn *insn = get_insns ();
1395 while (insn != NULL
1396 && !(JUMP_P (insn)
1397 && get_attr_far_jump (insn) == FAR_JUMP_YES))
1398 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
1399 return (insn != NULL);
1402 /* For the FRV, this function makes sure that a function with far jumps
1403 will return correctly. It also does the VLIW packing. */
1405 static void
1406 frv_function_prologue (FILE *file, HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1408 rtx_insn *insn, *next, *last_call;
1410 /* If no frame was created, check whether the function uses a call
1411 instruction to implement a far jump. If so, save the link in gr3 and
1412 replace all returns to LR with returns to GR3. GR3 is used because it
1413 is call-clobbered, because is not available to the register allocator,
1414 and because all functions that take a hidden argument pointer will have
1415 a stack frame. */
1416 if (frv_stack_info ()->total_size == 0 && frv_function_contains_far_jump ())
1418 rtx_insn *insn;
1420 /* Just to check that the above comment is true. */
1421 gcc_assert (!df_regs_ever_live_p (GPR_FIRST + 3));
1423 /* Generate the instruction that saves the link register. */
1424 fprintf (file, "\tmovsg lr,gr3\n");
1426 /* Replace the LR with GR3 in *return_internal patterns. The insn
1427 will now return using jmpl @(gr3,0) rather than bralr. We cannot
1428 simply emit a different assembly directive because bralr and jmpl
1429 execute in different units. */
1430 for (insn = get_insns(); insn != NULL; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1431 if (JUMP_P (insn))
1433 rtx pattern = PATTERN (insn);
1434 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == PARALLEL
1435 && XVECLEN (pattern, 0) >= 2
1436 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 0)) == RETURN
1437 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 1)) == USE)
1439 rtx address = XEXP (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 1), 0);
1440 if (GET_CODE (address) == REG && REGNO (address) == LR_REGNO)
1441 SET_REGNO (address, GPR_FIRST + 3);
1446 frv_pack_insns ();
1448 /* Allow the garbage collector to free the nops created by frv_reorg. */
1449 memset (frv_nops, 0, sizeof (frv_nops));
1451 /* Locate CALL_ARG_LOCATION notes that have been misplaced
1452 and move them back to where they should be located. */
1453 last_call = NULL;
1454 for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = next)
1456 next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
1457 if (CALL_P (insn)
1458 || (INSN_P (insn) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE
1459 && CALL_P (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0))))
1460 last_call = insn;
1462 if (!NOTE_P (insn) || NOTE_KIND (insn) != NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION)
1463 continue;
1465 if (NEXT_INSN (last_call) == insn)
1466 continue;
1468 SET_NEXT_INSN (PREV_INSN (insn)) = NEXT_INSN (insn);
1469 SET_PREV_INSN (NEXT_INSN (insn)) = PREV_INSN (insn);
1470 SET_PREV_INSN (insn) = last_call;
1471 SET_NEXT_INSN (insn) = NEXT_INSN (last_call);
1472 SET_PREV_INSN (NEXT_INSN (insn)) = insn;
1473 SET_NEXT_INSN (PREV_INSN (insn)) = insn;
1474 last_call = insn;
1479 /* Return the next available temporary register in a given class. */
1481 static rtx
1482 frv_alloc_temp_reg (
1483 frv_tmp_reg_t *info, /* which registers are available */
1484 enum reg_class rclass, /* register class desired */
1485 enum machine_mode mode, /* mode to allocate register with */
1486 int mark_as_used, /* register not available after allocation */
1487 int no_abort) /* return NULL instead of aborting */
1489 int regno = info->next_reg[ (int)rclass ];
1490 int orig_regno = regno;
1491 HARD_REG_SET *reg_in_class = &reg_class_contents[ (int)rclass ];
1492 int i, nr;
1494 for (;;)
1496 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*reg_in_class, regno)
1497 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (info->regs, regno))
1498 break;
1500 if (++regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1501 regno = 0;
1502 if (regno == orig_regno)
1504 gcc_assert (no_abort);
1505 return NULL_RTX;
1509 nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);
1510 info->next_reg[ (int)rclass ] = regno + nr;
1512 if (mark_as_used)
1513 for (i = 0; i < nr; i++)
1514 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (info->regs, regno+i);
1516 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, regno);
1520 /* Return an rtx with the value OFFSET, which will either be a register or a
1521 signed 12-bit integer. It can be used as the second operand in an "add"
1522 instruction, or as the index in a load or store.
1524 The function returns a constant rtx if OFFSET is small enough, otherwise
1525 it loads the constant into register OFFSET_REGNO and returns that. */
1526 static rtx
1527 frv_frame_offset_rtx (int offset)
1529 rtx offset_rtx = GEN_INT (offset);
1530 if (IN_RANGE (offset, -2048, 2047))
1531 return offset_rtx;
1532 else
1534 rtx reg_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, OFFSET_REGNO);
1535 if (IN_RANGE (offset, -32768, 32767))
1536 emit_insn (gen_movsi (reg_rtx, offset_rtx));
1537 else
1539 emit_insn (gen_movsi_high (reg_rtx, offset_rtx));
1540 emit_insn (gen_movsi_lo_sum (reg_rtx, offset_rtx));
1542 return reg_rtx;
1546 /* Generate (mem:MODE (plus:Pmode BASE (frv_frame_offset OFFSET)))). The
1547 prologue and epilogue uses such expressions to access the stack. */
1548 static rtx
1549 frv_frame_mem (enum machine_mode mode, rtx base, int offset)
1551 return gen_rtx_MEM (mode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
1552 base,
1553 frv_frame_offset_rtx (offset)));
1556 /* Generate a frame-related expression:
1558 (set REG (mem (plus (sp) (const_int OFFSET)))).
1560 Such expressions are used in FRAME_RELATED_EXPR notes for more complex
1561 instructions. Marking the expressions as frame-related is superfluous if
1562 the note contains just a single set. But if the note contains a PARALLEL
1563 or SEQUENCE that has several sets, each set must be individually marked
1564 as frame-related. */
1565 static rtx
1566 frv_dwarf_store (rtx reg, int offset)
1568 rtx set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
1569 gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (reg),
1570 plus_constant (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
1571 offset)),
1572 reg);
1573 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (set) = 1;
1574 return set;
1577 /* Emit a frame-related instruction whose pattern is PATTERN. The
1578 instruction is the last in a sequence that cumulatively performs the
1579 operation described by DWARF_PATTERN. The instruction is marked as
1580 frame-related and has a REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR note containing
1581 DWARF_PATTERN. */
1582 static void
1583 frv_frame_insn (rtx pattern, rtx dwarf_pattern)
1585 rtx insn = emit_insn (pattern);
1586 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
1587 REG_NOTES (insn) = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR,
1588 dwarf_pattern,
1589 REG_NOTES (insn));
1592 /* Emit instructions that transfer REG to or from the memory location (sp +
1593 STACK_OFFSET). The register is stored in memory if ACCESSOR->OP is
1594 FRV_STORE and loaded if it is FRV_LOAD. Only the prologue uses this
1595 function to store registers and only the epilogue uses it to load them.
1597 The caller sets up ACCESSOR so that BASE is equal to (sp + BASE_OFFSET).
1598 The generated instruction will use BASE as its base register. BASE may
1599 simply be the stack pointer, but if several accesses are being made to a
1600 region far away from the stack pointer, it may be more efficient to set
1601 up a temporary instead.
1603 Store instructions will be frame-related and will be annotated with the
1604 overall effect of the store. Load instructions will be followed by a
1605 (use) to prevent later optimizations from zapping them.
1607 The function takes care of the moves to and from SPRs, using TEMP_REGNO
1608 as a temporary in such cases. */
1609 static void
1610 frv_frame_access (frv_frame_accessor_t *accessor, rtx reg, int stack_offset)
1612 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (reg);
1613 rtx mem = frv_frame_mem (mode,
1614 accessor->base,
1615 stack_offset - accessor->base_offset);
1617 if (accessor->op == FRV_LOAD)
1619 if (SPR_P (REGNO (reg)))
1621 rtx temp = gen_rtx_REG (mode, TEMP_REGNO);
1622 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, temp, mem));
1623 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, temp));
1625 else
1627 /* We cannot use reg+reg addressing for DImode access. */
1628 if (mode == DImode
1629 && GET_CODE (XEXP (mem, 0)) == PLUS
1630 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 0)) == REG
1631 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 1)) == REG)
1633 rtx temp = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, TEMP_REGNO);
1635 emit_move_insn (temp,
1636 gen_rtx_PLUS (SImode, XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 0),
1637 XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 1)));
1638 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, temp);
1640 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, mem));
1642 emit_use (reg);
1644 else
1646 if (SPR_P (REGNO (reg)))
1648 rtx temp = gen_rtx_REG (mode, TEMP_REGNO);
1649 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, temp, reg));
1650 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (Pmode, mem, temp),
1651 frv_dwarf_store (reg, stack_offset));
1653 else if (mode == DImode)
1655 /* For DImode saves, the dwarf2 version needs to be a SEQUENCE
1656 with a separate save for each register. */
1657 rtx reg1 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (reg));
1658 rtx reg2 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (reg) + 1);
1659 rtx set1 = frv_dwarf_store (reg1, stack_offset);
1660 rtx set2 = frv_dwarf_store (reg2, stack_offset + 4);
1662 /* Also we cannot use reg+reg addressing. */
1663 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (mem, 0)) == PLUS
1664 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 0)) == REG
1665 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 1)) == REG)
1667 rtx temp = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, TEMP_REGNO);
1668 emit_move_insn (temp,
1669 gen_rtx_PLUS (SImode, XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 0),
1670 XEXP (XEXP (mem, 0), 1)));
1671 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, temp);
1674 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (Pmode, mem, reg),
1675 gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode,
1676 gen_rtvec (2, set1, set2)));
1678 else
1679 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (Pmode, mem, reg),
1680 frv_dwarf_store (reg, stack_offset));
1684 /* A function that uses frv_frame_access to transfer a group of registers to
1685 or from the stack. ACCESSOR is passed directly to frv_frame_access, INFO
1686 is the stack information generated by frv_stack_info, and REG_SET is the
1687 number of the register set to transfer. */
1688 static void
1689 frv_frame_access_multi (frv_frame_accessor_t *accessor,
1690 frv_stack_t *info,
1691 int reg_set)
1693 frv_stack_regs_t *regs_info;
1694 int regno;
1696 regs_info = &info->regs[reg_set];
1697 for (regno = regs_info->first; regno <= regs_info->last; regno++)
1698 if (info->save_p[regno])
1699 frv_frame_access (accessor,
1700 info->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS
1701 ? gen_rtx_REG (DImode, regno)
1702 : gen_rtx_REG (SImode, regno),
1703 info->reg_offset[regno]);
1706 /* Save or restore callee-saved registers that are kept outside the frame
1707 header. The function saves the registers if OP is FRV_STORE and restores
1708 them if OP is FRV_LOAD. INFO is the stack information generated by
1709 frv_stack_info. */
1710 static void
1711 frv_frame_access_standard_regs (enum frv_stack_op op, frv_stack_t *info)
1713 frv_frame_accessor_t accessor;
1715 accessor.op = op;
1716 accessor.base = stack_pointer_rtx;
1717 accessor.base_offset = 0;
1718 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_GPR);
1719 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_FPR);
1720 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_LCR);
1724 /* Called after register allocation to add any instructions needed for the
1725 prologue. Using a prologue insn is favored compared to putting all of the
1726 instructions in the TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE target hook, since
1727 it allows the scheduler to intermix instructions with the saves of
1728 the caller saved registers. In some cases, it might be necessary
1729 to emit a barrier instruction as the last insn to prevent such
1730 scheduling.
1732 Also any insns generated here should have RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P(insn) = 1
1733 so that the debug info generation code can handle them properly. */
1734 void
1735 frv_expand_prologue (void)
1737 frv_stack_t *info = frv_stack_info ();
1738 rtx sp = stack_pointer_rtx;
1739 rtx fp = frame_pointer_rtx;
1740 frv_frame_accessor_t accessor;
1742 if (TARGET_DEBUG_STACK)
1743 frv_debug_stack (info);
1745 if (flag_stack_usage_info)
1746 current_function_static_stack_size = info->total_size;
1748 if (info->total_size == 0)
1749 return;
1751 /* We're interested in three areas of the frame here:
1753 A: the register save area
1754 B: the old FP
1755 C: the header after B
1757 If the frame pointer isn't used, we'll have to set up A, B and C
1758 using the stack pointer. If the frame pointer is used, we'll access
1759 them as follows:
1761 A: set up using sp
1762 B: set up using sp or a temporary (see below)
1763 C: set up using fp
1765 We set up B using the stack pointer if the frame is small enough.
1766 Otherwise, it's more efficient to copy the old stack pointer into a
1767 temporary and use that.
1769 Note that it's important to make sure the prologue and epilogue use the
1770 same registers to access A and C, since doing otherwise will confuse
1771 the aliasing code. */
1773 /* Set up ACCESSOR for accessing region B above. If the frame pointer
1774 isn't used, the same method will serve for C. */
1775 accessor.op = FRV_STORE;
1776 if (frame_pointer_needed && info->total_size > 2048)
1778 accessor.base = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, OLD_SP_REGNO);
1779 accessor.base_offset = info->total_size;
1780 emit_insn (gen_movsi (accessor.base, sp));
1782 else
1784 accessor.base = stack_pointer_rtx;
1785 accessor.base_offset = 0;
1788 /* Allocate the stack space. */
1790 rtx asm_offset = frv_frame_offset_rtx (-info->total_size);
1791 rtx dwarf_offset = GEN_INT (-info->total_size);
1793 frv_frame_insn (gen_stack_adjust (sp, sp, asm_offset),
1794 gen_rtx_SET (Pmode,
1796 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, sp, dwarf_offset)));
1799 /* If the frame pointer is needed, store the old one at (sp + FP_OFFSET)
1800 and point the new one to that location. */
1801 if (frame_pointer_needed)
1803 int fp_offset = info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM];
1805 /* ASM_SRC and DWARF_SRC both point to the frame header. ASM_SRC is
1806 based on ACCESSOR.BASE but DWARF_SRC is always based on the stack
1807 pointer. */
1808 rtx asm_src = plus_constant (Pmode, accessor.base,
1809 fp_offset - accessor.base_offset);
1810 rtx dwarf_src = plus_constant (Pmode, sp, fp_offset);
1812 /* Store the old frame pointer at (sp + FP_OFFSET). */
1813 frv_frame_access (&accessor, fp, fp_offset);
1815 /* Set up the new frame pointer. */
1816 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, fp, asm_src),
1817 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, fp, dwarf_src));
1819 /* Access region C from the frame pointer. */
1820 accessor.base = fp;
1821 accessor.base_offset = fp_offset;
1824 /* Set up region C. */
1825 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_STRUCT);
1826 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_LR);
1827 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_STDARG);
1829 /* Set up region A. */
1830 frv_frame_access_standard_regs (FRV_STORE, info);
1832 /* If this is a varargs/stdarg function, issue a blockage to prevent the
1833 scheduler from moving loads before the stores saving the registers. */
1834 if (info->stdarg_size > 0)
1835 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
1837 /* Set up pic register/small data register for this function. */
1838 if (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic && crtl->uses_pic_offset_table)
1839 emit_insn (gen_pic_prologue (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, PIC_REGNO),
1840 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO),
1841 gen_rtx_REG (SImode, OFFSET_REGNO)));
1845 /* Under frv, all of the work is done via frv_expand_epilogue, but
1846 this function provides a convenient place to do cleanup. */
1848 static void
1849 frv_function_epilogue (FILE *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1850 HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1852 frv_stack_cache = (frv_stack_t *)0;
1854 /* Zap last used registers for conditional execution. */
1855 memset (&frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg, 0, sizeof (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg));
1857 /* Release the bitmap of created insns. */
1858 BITMAP_FREE (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap);
1862 /* Called after register allocation to add any instructions needed for the
1863 epilogue. Using an epilogue insn is favored compared to putting all of the
1864 instructions in the TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE target hook, since
1865 it allows the scheduler to intermix instructions with the saves of
1866 the caller saved registers. In some cases, it might be necessary
1867 to emit a barrier instruction as the last insn to prevent such
1868 scheduling. */
1870 void
1871 frv_expand_epilogue (bool emit_return)
1873 frv_stack_t *info = frv_stack_info ();
1874 rtx fp = frame_pointer_rtx;
1875 rtx sp = stack_pointer_rtx;
1876 rtx return_addr;
1877 int fp_offset;
1879 fp_offset = info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM];
1881 /* Restore the stack pointer to its original value if alloca or the like
1882 is used. */
1883 if (! crtl->sp_is_unchanging)
1884 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (sp, fp, frv_frame_offset_rtx (-fp_offset)));
1886 /* Restore the callee-saved registers that were used in this function. */
1887 frv_frame_access_standard_regs (FRV_LOAD, info);
1889 /* Set RETURN_ADDR to the address we should return to. Set it to NULL if
1890 no return instruction should be emitted. */
1891 if (info->save_p[LR_REGNO])
1893 int lr_offset;
1894 rtx mem;
1896 /* Use the same method to access the link register's slot as we did in
1897 the prologue. In other words, use the frame pointer if available,
1898 otherwise use the stack pointer.
1900 LR_OFFSET is the offset of the link register's slot from the start
1901 of the frame and MEM is a memory rtx for it. */
1902 lr_offset = info->reg_offset[LR_REGNO];
1903 if (frame_pointer_needed)
1904 mem = frv_frame_mem (Pmode, fp, lr_offset - fp_offset);
1905 else
1906 mem = frv_frame_mem (Pmode, sp, lr_offset);
1908 /* Load the old link register into a GPR. */
1909 return_addr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, TEMP_REGNO);
1910 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, return_addr, mem));
1912 else
1913 return_addr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO);
1915 /* Restore the old frame pointer. Emit a USE afterwards to make sure
1916 the load is preserved. */
1917 if (frame_pointer_needed)
1919 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, fp, gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, fp)));
1920 emit_use (fp);
1923 /* Deallocate the stack frame. */
1924 if (info->total_size != 0)
1926 rtx offset = frv_frame_offset_rtx (info->total_size);
1927 emit_insn (gen_stack_adjust (sp, sp, offset));
1930 /* If this function uses eh_return, add the final stack adjustment now. */
1931 if (crtl->calls_eh_return)
1932 emit_insn (gen_stack_adjust (sp, sp, EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX));
1934 if (emit_return)
1935 emit_jump_insn (gen_epilogue_return (return_addr));
1936 else
1938 rtx lr = return_addr;
1940 if (REGNO (return_addr) != LR_REGNO)
1942 lr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO);
1943 emit_move_insn (lr, return_addr);
1946 emit_use (lr);
1951 /* Worker function for TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK. */
1953 static void
1954 frv_asm_output_mi_thunk (FILE *file,
1955 tree thunk_fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1956 HOST_WIDE_INT delta,
1957 HOST_WIDE_INT vcall_offset ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1958 tree function)
1960 const char *name_func = XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (function), 0), 0);
1961 const char *name_arg0 = reg_names[FIRST_ARG_REGNUM];
1962 const char *name_jmp = reg_names[JUMP_REGNO];
1963 const char *parallel = (frv_issue_rate () > 1 ? ".p" : "");
1965 /* Do the add using an addi if possible. */
1966 if (IN_RANGE (delta, -2048, 2047))
1967 fprintf (file, "\taddi %s,#%d,%s\n", name_arg0, (int) delta, name_arg0);
1968 else
1970 const char *const name_add = reg_names[TEMP_REGNO];
1971 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #hi(" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "),%s\n",
1972 parallel, delta, name_add);
1973 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #lo(" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "),%s\n",
1974 delta, name_add);
1975 fprintf (file, "\tadd %s,%s,%s\n", name_add, name_arg0, name_arg0);
1978 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
1980 const char *name_pic = reg_names[FDPIC_REGNO];
1981 name_jmp = reg_names[FDPIC_FPTR_REGNO];
1983 if (flag_pic != 1)
1985 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #gotofffuncdeschi(", parallel);
1986 assemble_name (file, name_func);
1987 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
1989 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #gotofffuncdesclo(");
1990 assemble_name (file, name_func);
1991 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
1993 fprintf (file, "\tldd @(%s,%s), %s\n", name_jmp, name_pic, name_jmp);
1995 else
1997 fprintf (file, "\tlddo @(%s,#gotofffuncdesc12(", name_pic);
1998 assemble_name (file, name_func);
1999 fprintf (file, "\t)), %s\n", name_jmp);
2002 else if (!flag_pic)
2004 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #hi(", parallel);
2005 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2006 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
2008 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #lo(");
2009 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2010 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
2012 else
2014 /* Use JUMP_REGNO as a temporary PIC register. */
2015 const char *name_lr = reg_names[LR_REGNO];
2016 const char *name_gppic = name_jmp;
2017 const char *name_tmp = reg_names[TEMP_REGNO];
2019 fprintf (file, "\tmovsg %s,%s\n", name_lr, name_tmp);
2020 fprintf (file, "\tcall 1f\n");
2021 fprintf (file, "1:\tmovsg %s,%s\n", name_lr, name_gppic);
2022 fprintf (file, "\tmovgs %s,%s\n", name_tmp, name_lr);
2023 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #gprelhi(1b),%s\n", parallel, name_tmp);
2024 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #gprello(1b),%s\n", name_tmp);
2025 fprintf (file, "\tsub %s,%s,%s\n", name_gppic, name_tmp, name_gppic);
2027 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #gprelhi(", parallel);
2028 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2029 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_tmp);
2031 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #gprello(");
2032 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2033 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_tmp);
2035 fprintf (file, "\tadd %s,%s,%s\n", name_gppic, name_tmp, name_jmp);
2038 /* Jump to the function address. */
2039 fprintf (file, "\tjmpl @(%s,%s)\n", name_jmp, reg_names[GPR_FIRST+0]);
2044 /* On frv, create a frame whenever we need to create stack. */
2046 static bool
2047 frv_frame_pointer_required (void)
2049 /* If we forgoing the usual linkage requirements, we only need
2050 a frame pointer if the stack pointer might change. */
2051 if (!TARGET_LINKED_FP)
2052 return !crtl->sp_is_unchanging;
2054 if (! crtl->is_leaf)
2055 return true;
2057 if (get_frame_size () != 0)
2058 return true;
2060 if (cfun->stdarg)
2061 return true;
2063 if (!crtl->sp_is_unchanging)
2064 return true;
2066 if (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic && crtl->uses_pic_offset_table)
2067 return true;
2069 if (profile_flag)
2070 return true;
2072 if (cfun->machine->frame_needed)
2073 return true;
2075 return false;
2079 /* Worker function for TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE. */
2081 bool
2082 frv_can_eliminate (const int from, const int to)
2084 return (from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM && to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2085 ? ! frame_pointer_needed
2086 : true);
2089 /* This macro is similar to `INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET'. It specifies the
2090 initial difference between the specified pair of registers. This macro must
2091 be defined if `ELIMINABLE_REGS' is defined. */
2093 /* See frv_stack_info for more details on the frv stack frame. */
2096 frv_initial_elimination_offset (int from, int to)
2098 frv_stack_t *info = frv_stack_info ();
2099 int ret = 0;
2101 if (to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM && from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
2102 ret = info->total_size - info->pretend_size;
2104 else if (to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM && from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2105 ret = info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM];
2107 else if (to == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
2108 ret = (info->total_size
2109 - info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM]
2110 - info->pretend_size);
2112 else
2113 gcc_unreachable ();
2115 if (TARGET_DEBUG_STACK)
2116 fprintf (stderr, "Eliminate %s to %s by adding %d\n",
2117 reg_names [from], reg_names[to], ret);
2119 return ret;
2123 /* Worker function for TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS. */
2125 static void
2126 frv_setup_incoming_varargs (cumulative_args_t cum_v,
2127 enum machine_mode mode,
2128 tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2129 int *pretend_size,
2130 int second_time)
2132 CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v);
2134 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
2135 fprintf (stderr,
2136 "setup_vararg: words = %2d, mode = %4s, pretend_size = %d, second_time = %d\n",
2137 *cum, GET_MODE_NAME (mode), *pretend_size, second_time);
2141 /* Worker function for TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS. */
2143 static rtx
2144 frv_expand_builtin_saveregs (void)
2146 int offset = UNITS_PER_WORD * FRV_NUM_ARG_REGS;
2148 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
2149 fprintf (stderr, "expand_builtin_saveregs: offset from ap = %d\n",
2150 offset);
2152 return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_incoming_args_rtx, GEN_INT (- offset));
2156 /* Expand __builtin_va_start to do the va_start macro. */
2158 static void
2159 frv_expand_builtin_va_start (tree valist, rtx nextarg)
2161 tree t;
2162 int num = crtl->args.info - FIRST_ARG_REGNUM - FRV_NUM_ARG_REGS;
2164 nextarg = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_incoming_args_rtx,
2165 GEN_INT (UNITS_PER_WORD * num));
2167 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
2169 fprintf (stderr, "va_start: args_info = %d, num = %d\n",
2170 crtl->args.info, num);
2172 debug_rtx (nextarg);
2175 t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (valist), valist,
2176 fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (valist),
2177 make_tree (sizetype, nextarg)));
2178 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1;
2180 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
2184 /* Expand a block move operation, and return 1 if successful. Return 0
2185 if we should let the compiler generate normal code.
2187 operands[0] is the destination
2188 operands[1] is the source
2189 operands[2] is the length
2190 operands[3] is the alignment */
2192 /* Maximum number of loads to do before doing the stores */
2193 #ifndef MAX_MOVE_REG
2194 #define MAX_MOVE_REG 4
2195 #endif
2197 /* Maximum number of total loads to do. */
2198 #ifndef TOTAL_MOVE_REG
2199 #define TOTAL_MOVE_REG 8
2200 #endif
2203 frv_expand_block_move (rtx operands[])
2205 rtx orig_dest = operands[0];
2206 rtx orig_src = operands[1];
2207 rtx bytes_rtx = operands[2];
2208 rtx align_rtx = operands[3];
2209 int constp = (GET_CODE (bytes_rtx) == CONST_INT);
2210 int align;
2211 int bytes;
2212 int offset;
2213 int num_reg;
2214 int i;
2215 rtx src_reg;
2216 rtx dest_reg;
2217 rtx src_addr;
2218 rtx dest_addr;
2219 rtx src_mem;
2220 rtx dest_mem;
2221 rtx tmp_reg;
2222 rtx stores[MAX_MOVE_REG];
2223 int move_bytes;
2224 enum machine_mode mode;
2226 /* If this is not a fixed size move, just call memcpy. */
2227 if (! constp)
2228 return FALSE;
2230 /* This should be a fixed size alignment. */
2231 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (align_rtx) == CONST_INT);
2233 align = INTVAL (align_rtx);
2235 /* Anything to move? */
2236 bytes = INTVAL (bytes_rtx);
2237 if (bytes <= 0)
2238 return TRUE;
2240 /* Don't support real large moves. */
2241 if (bytes > TOTAL_MOVE_REG*align)
2242 return FALSE;
2244 /* Move the address into scratch registers. */
2245 dest_reg = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_dest, 0));
2246 src_reg = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_src, 0));
2248 num_reg = offset = 0;
2249 for ( ; bytes > 0; (bytes -= move_bytes), (offset += move_bytes))
2251 /* Calculate the correct offset for src/dest. */
2252 if (offset == 0)
2254 src_addr = src_reg;
2255 dest_addr = dest_reg;
2257 else
2259 src_addr = plus_constant (Pmode, src_reg, offset);
2260 dest_addr = plus_constant (Pmode, dest_reg, offset);
2263 /* Generate the appropriate load and store, saving the stores
2264 for later. */
2265 if (bytes >= 4 && align >= 4)
2266 mode = SImode;
2267 else if (bytes >= 2 && align >= 2)
2268 mode = HImode;
2269 else
2270 mode = QImode;
2272 move_bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2273 tmp_reg = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2274 src_mem = change_address (orig_src, mode, src_addr);
2275 dest_mem = change_address (orig_dest, mode, dest_addr);
2276 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, tmp_reg, src_mem));
2277 stores[num_reg++] = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest_mem, tmp_reg);
2279 if (num_reg >= MAX_MOVE_REG)
2281 for (i = 0; i < num_reg; i++)
2282 emit_insn (stores[i]);
2283 num_reg = 0;
2287 for (i = 0; i < num_reg; i++)
2288 emit_insn (stores[i]);
2290 return TRUE;
2294 /* Expand a block clear operation, and return 1 if successful. Return 0
2295 if we should let the compiler generate normal code.
2297 operands[0] is the destination
2298 operands[1] is the length
2299 operands[3] is the alignment */
2302 frv_expand_block_clear (rtx operands[])
2304 rtx orig_dest = operands[0];
2305 rtx bytes_rtx = operands[1];
2306 rtx align_rtx = operands[3];
2307 int constp = (GET_CODE (bytes_rtx) == CONST_INT);
2308 int align;
2309 int bytes;
2310 int offset;
2311 rtx dest_reg;
2312 rtx dest_addr;
2313 rtx dest_mem;
2314 int clear_bytes;
2315 enum machine_mode mode;
2317 /* If this is not a fixed size move, just call memcpy. */
2318 if (! constp)
2319 return FALSE;
2321 /* This should be a fixed size alignment. */
2322 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (align_rtx) == CONST_INT);
2324 align = INTVAL (align_rtx);
2326 /* Anything to move? */
2327 bytes = INTVAL (bytes_rtx);
2328 if (bytes <= 0)
2329 return TRUE;
2331 /* Don't support real large clears. */
2332 if (bytes > TOTAL_MOVE_REG*align)
2333 return FALSE;
2335 /* Move the address into a scratch register. */
2336 dest_reg = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_dest, 0));
2338 offset = 0;
2339 for ( ; bytes > 0; (bytes -= clear_bytes), (offset += clear_bytes))
2341 /* Calculate the correct offset for src/dest. */
2342 dest_addr = ((offset == 0)
2343 ? dest_reg
2344 : plus_constant (Pmode, dest_reg, offset));
2346 /* Generate the appropriate store of gr0. */
2347 if (bytes >= 4 && align >= 4)
2348 mode = SImode;
2349 else if (bytes >= 2 && align >= 2)
2350 mode = HImode;
2351 else
2352 mode = QImode;
2354 clear_bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2355 dest_mem = change_address (orig_dest, mode, dest_addr);
2356 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest_mem, const0_rtx));
2359 return TRUE;
2363 /* The following variable is used to output modifiers of assembler
2364 code of the current output insn. */
2366 static rtx *frv_insn_operands;
2368 /* The following function is used to add assembler insn code suffix .p
2369 if it is necessary. */
2371 const char *
2372 frv_asm_output_opcode (FILE *f, const char *ptr)
2374 int c;
2376 if (frv_insn_packing_flag <= 0)
2377 return ptr;
2379 for (; *ptr && *ptr != ' ' && *ptr != '\t';)
2381 c = *ptr++;
2382 if (c == '%' && ((*ptr >= 'a' && *ptr <= 'z')
2383 || (*ptr >= 'A' && *ptr <= 'Z')))
2385 int letter = *ptr++;
2387 c = atoi (ptr);
2388 frv_print_operand (f, frv_insn_operands [c], letter);
2389 while ((c = *ptr) >= '0' && c <= '9')
2390 ptr++;
2392 else
2393 fputc (c, f);
2396 fprintf (f, ".p");
2398 return ptr;
2401 /* Set up the packing bit for the current output insn. Note that this
2402 function is not called for asm insns. */
2404 void
2405 frv_final_prescan_insn (rtx_insn *insn, rtx *opvec,
2406 int noperands ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2408 if (INSN_P (insn))
2410 if (frv_insn_packing_flag >= 0)
2412 frv_insn_operands = opvec;
2413 frv_insn_packing_flag = PACKING_FLAG_P (insn);
2415 else if (recog_memoized (insn) >= 0
2416 && get_attr_acc_group (insn) == ACC_GROUP_ODD)
2417 /* Packing optimizations have been disabled, but INSN can only
2418 be issued in M1. Insert an mnop in M0. */
2419 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmnop.p\n");
2425 /* A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack frame
2426 where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that FRAMEADDR is
2427 an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame itself.
2429 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value of
2430 FRAMEADDR--that is, the stack frame address is also the address of the stack
2431 word that points to the previous frame. */
2433 /* The default is correct, but we need to make sure the frame gets created. */
2435 frv_dynamic_chain_address (rtx frame)
2437 cfun->machine->frame_needed = 1;
2438 return frame;
2442 /* A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
2443 address for the frame COUNT steps up from the current frame, after the
2444 prologue. FRAMEADDR is the frame pointer of the COUNT frame, or the frame
2445 pointer of the COUNT - 1 frame if `RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME' is
2446 defined.
2448 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when COUNT is
2449 zero, but may be `NULL_RTX' if there is not way to determine the return
2450 address of other frames. */
2453 frv_return_addr_rtx (int count, rtx frame)
2455 if (count != 0)
2456 return const0_rtx;
2457 cfun->machine->frame_needed = 1;
2458 return gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, plus_constant (Pmode, frame, 8));
2461 /* Given a memory reference MEMREF, interpret the referenced memory as
2462 an array of MODE values, and return a reference to the element
2463 specified by INDEX. Assume that any pre-modification implicit in
2464 MEMREF has already happened.
2466 MEMREF must be a legitimate operand for modes larger than SImode.
2467 frv_legitimate_address_p forbids register+register addresses, which
2468 this function cannot handle. */
2470 frv_index_memory (rtx memref, enum machine_mode mode, int index)
2472 rtx base = XEXP (memref, 0);
2473 if (GET_CODE (base) == PRE_MODIFY)
2474 base = XEXP (base, 0);
2475 return change_address (memref, mode,
2476 plus_constant (Pmode, base,
2477 index * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)));
2481 /* Print a memory address as an operand to reference that memory location. */
2482 static void
2483 frv_print_operand_address (FILE * stream, rtx x)
2485 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
2486 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2488 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2490 case REG:
2491 fputs (reg_names [ REGNO (x)], stream);
2492 return;
2494 case CONST_INT:
2495 fprintf (stream, "%ld", (long) INTVAL (x));
2496 return;
2498 case SYMBOL_REF:
2499 assemble_name (stream, XSTR (x, 0));
2500 return;
2502 case LABEL_REF:
2503 case CONST:
2504 output_addr_const (stream, x);
2505 return;
2507 case PLUS:
2508 /* Poorly constructed asm statements can trigger this alternative.
2509 See gcc/testsuite/gcc.dg/asm-4.c for an example. */
2510 frv_print_operand_memory_reference (stream, x, 0);
2511 return;
2513 default:
2514 break;
2517 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_address:", x);
2521 static void
2522 frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg (FILE * stream, rtx x)
2524 int regno = true_regnum (x);
2525 if (GPR_P (regno))
2526 fputs (reg_names[regno], stream);
2527 else
2528 fatal_insn ("bad register to frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg:", x);
2531 /* Print a memory reference suitable for the ld/st instructions. */
2533 static void
2534 frv_print_operand_memory_reference (FILE * stream, rtx x, int addr_offset)
2536 struct frv_unspec unspec;
2537 rtx x0 = NULL_RTX;
2538 rtx x1 = NULL_RTX;
2540 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2542 case SUBREG:
2543 case REG:
2544 x0 = x;
2545 break;
2547 case PRE_MODIFY: /* (pre_modify (reg) (plus (reg) (reg))) */
2548 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
2549 x1 = XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1);
2550 break;
2552 case CONST_INT:
2553 x1 = x;
2554 break;
2556 case PLUS:
2557 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
2558 x1 = XEXP (x, 1);
2559 if (GET_CODE (x0) == CONST_INT)
2561 x0 = XEXP (x, 1);
2562 x1 = XEXP (x, 0);
2564 break;
2566 default:
2567 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
2568 break;
2572 if (addr_offset)
2574 if (!x1)
2575 x1 = const0_rtx;
2576 else if (GET_CODE (x1) != CONST_INT)
2577 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
2580 fputs ("@(", stream);
2581 if (!x0)
2582 fputs (reg_names[GPR_R0], stream);
2583 else if (GET_CODE (x0) == REG || GET_CODE (x0) == SUBREG)
2584 frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg (stream, x0);
2585 else
2586 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
2588 fputs (",", stream);
2589 if (!x1)
2590 fputs (reg_names [GPR_R0], stream);
2592 else
2594 switch (GET_CODE (x1))
2596 case SUBREG:
2597 case REG:
2598 frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg (stream, x1);
2599 break;
2601 case CONST_INT:
2602 fprintf (stream, "%ld", (long) (INTVAL (x1) + addr_offset));
2603 break;
2605 case CONST:
2606 if (!frv_const_unspec_p (x1, &unspec))
2607 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x1);
2608 frv_output_const_unspec (stream, &unspec);
2609 break;
2611 default:
2612 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
2616 fputs (")", stream);
2620 /* Return 2 for likely branches and 0 for non-likely branches */
2622 #define FRV_JUMP_LIKELY 2
2623 #define FRV_JUMP_NOT_LIKELY 0
2625 static int
2626 frv_print_operand_jump_hint (rtx_insn *insn)
2628 rtx note;
2629 rtx labelref;
2630 int ret;
2631 int prob = -1;
2632 enum { UNKNOWN, BACKWARD, FORWARD } jump_type = UNKNOWN;
2634 gcc_assert (JUMP_P (insn));
2636 /* Assume any non-conditional jump is likely. */
2637 if (! any_condjump_p (insn))
2638 ret = FRV_JUMP_LIKELY;
2640 else
2642 labelref = condjump_label (insn);
2643 if (labelref)
2645 rtx label = XEXP (labelref, 0);
2646 jump_type = (insn_current_address > INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (label))
2647 ? BACKWARD
2648 : FORWARD);
2651 note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_BR_PROB, 0);
2652 if (!note)
2653 ret = ((jump_type == BACKWARD) ? FRV_JUMP_LIKELY : FRV_JUMP_NOT_LIKELY);
2655 else
2657 prob = XINT (note, 0);
2658 ret = ((prob >= (REG_BR_PROB_BASE / 2))
2659 ? FRV_JUMP_LIKELY
2660 : FRV_JUMP_NOT_LIKELY);
2664 #if 0
2665 if (TARGET_DEBUG)
2667 char *direction;
2669 switch (jump_type)
2671 default:
2672 case UNKNOWN: direction = "unknown jump direction"; break;
2673 case BACKWARD: direction = "jump backward"; break;
2674 case FORWARD: direction = "jump forward"; break;
2677 fprintf (stderr,
2678 "%s: uid %ld, %s, probability = %d, max prob. = %d, hint = %d\n",
2679 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (current_function_decl)),
2680 (long)INSN_UID (insn), direction, prob,
2681 REG_BR_PROB_BASE, ret);
2683 #endif
2685 return ret;
2689 /* Return the comparison operator to use for CODE given that the ICC
2690 register is OP0. */
2692 static const char *
2693 comparison_string (enum rtx_code code, rtx op0)
2695 bool is_nz_p = GET_MODE (op0) == CC_NZmode;
2696 switch (code)
2698 default: output_operand_lossage ("bad condition code");
2699 case EQ: return "eq";
2700 case NE: return "ne";
2701 case LT: return is_nz_p ? "n" : "lt";
2702 case LE: return "le";
2703 case GT: return "gt";
2704 case GE: return is_nz_p ? "p" : "ge";
2705 case LTU: return is_nz_p ? "no" : "c";
2706 case LEU: return is_nz_p ? "eq" : "ls";
2707 case GTU: return is_nz_p ? "ne" : "hi";
2708 case GEU: return is_nz_p ? "ra" : "nc";
2712 /* Print an operand to an assembler instruction.
2714 `%' followed by a letter and a digit says to output an operand in an
2715 alternate fashion. Four letters have standard, built-in meanings
2716 described below. The hook `TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND' can define
2717 additional letters with nonstandard meanings.
2719 `%cDIGIT' can be used to substitute an operand that is a constant value
2720 without the syntax that normally indicates an immediate operand.
2722 `%nDIGIT' is like `%cDIGIT' except that the value of the constant is negated
2723 before printing.
2725 `%aDIGIT' can be used to substitute an operand as if it were a memory
2726 reference, with the actual operand treated as the address. This may be
2727 useful when outputting a "load address" instruction, because often the
2728 assembler syntax for such an instruction requires you to write the operand
2729 as if it were a memory reference.
2731 `%lDIGIT' is used to substitute a `label_ref' into a jump instruction.
2733 `%=' outputs a number which is unique to each instruction in the entire
2734 compilation. This is useful for making local labels to be referred to more
2735 than once in a single template that generates multiple assembler
2736 instructions.
2738 `%' followed by a punctuation character specifies a substitution that
2739 does not use an operand. Only one case is standard: `%%' outputs a
2740 `%' into the assembler code. Other nonstandard cases can be defined
2741 in the `TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND' hook. You must also define which
2742 punctuation characters are valid with the
2743 `TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P' hook. */
2745 static void
2746 frv_print_operand (FILE * file, rtx x, int code)
2748 struct frv_unspec unspec;
2749 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
2750 int offset;
2752 if (code != 0 && !ISALPHA (code))
2753 value = 0;
2755 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT)
2756 value = INTVAL (x);
2758 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
2760 if (GET_MODE (x) == SFmode)
2762 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
2763 long l;
2765 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, x);
2766 REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (rv, l);
2767 value = l;
2770 else if (GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode)
2771 value = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (x);
2773 else
2774 fatal_insn ("bad insn in frv_print_operand, bad const_double", x);
2777 else
2778 value = 0;
2780 switch (code)
2783 case '.':
2784 /* Output r0. */
2785 fputs (reg_names[GPR_R0], file);
2786 break;
2788 case '#':
2789 fprintf (file, "%d", frv_print_operand_jump_hint (current_output_insn));
2790 break;
2792 case '@':
2793 /* Output small data area base register (gr16). */
2794 fputs (reg_names[SDA_BASE_REG], file);
2795 break;
2797 case '~':
2798 /* Output pic register (gr17). */
2799 fputs (reg_names[PIC_REGNO], file);
2800 break;
2802 case '*':
2803 /* Output the temporary integer CCR register. */
2804 fputs (reg_names[ICR_TEMP], file);
2805 break;
2807 case '&':
2808 /* Output the temporary integer CC register. */
2809 fputs (reg_names[ICC_TEMP], file);
2810 break;
2812 /* case 'a': print an address. */
2814 case 'C':
2815 /* Print appropriate test for integer branch false operation. */
2816 fputs (comparison_string (reverse_condition (GET_CODE (x)),
2817 XEXP (x, 0)), file);
2818 break;
2820 case 'c':
2821 /* Print appropriate test for integer branch true operation. */
2822 fputs (comparison_string (GET_CODE (x), XEXP (x, 0)), file);
2823 break;
2825 case 'e':
2826 /* Print 1 for a NE and 0 for an EQ to give the final argument
2827 for a conditional instruction. */
2828 if (GET_CODE (x) == NE)
2829 fputs ("1", file);
2831 else if (GET_CODE (x) == EQ)
2832 fputs ("0", file);
2834 else
2835 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'e' modifier:", x);
2836 break;
2838 case 'F':
2839 /* Print appropriate test for floating point branch false operation. */
2840 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2842 default:
2843 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'F' modifier:", x);
2845 case EQ: fputs ("ne", file); break;
2846 case NE: fputs ("eq", file); break;
2847 case LT: fputs ("uge", file); break;
2848 case LE: fputs ("ug", file); break;
2849 case GT: fputs ("ule", file); break;
2850 case GE: fputs ("ul", file); break;
2852 break;
2854 case 'f':
2855 /* Print appropriate test for floating point branch true operation. */
2856 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2858 default:
2859 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'f' modifier:", x);
2861 case EQ: fputs ("eq", file); break;
2862 case NE: fputs ("ne", file); break;
2863 case LT: fputs ("lt", file); break;
2864 case LE: fputs ("le", file); break;
2865 case GT: fputs ("gt", file); break;
2866 case GE: fputs ("ge", file); break;
2868 break;
2870 case 'g':
2871 /* Print appropriate GOT function. */
2872 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT)
2873 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'g' modifier:", x);
2874 fputs (unspec_got_name (INTVAL (x)), file);
2875 break;
2877 case 'I':
2878 /* Print 'i' if the operand is a constant, or is a memory reference that
2879 adds a constant. */
2880 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
2881 x = ((GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS)
2882 ? XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)
2883 : XEXP (x, 0));
2884 else if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS)
2885 x = XEXP (x, 1);
2887 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2889 default:
2890 break;
2892 case CONST_INT:
2893 case SYMBOL_REF:
2894 case CONST:
2895 fputs ("i", file);
2896 break;
2898 break;
2900 case 'i':
2901 /* For jump instructions, print 'i' if the operand is a constant or
2902 is an expression that adds a constant. */
2903 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT)
2904 fputs ("i", file);
2906 else
2908 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT
2909 || (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
2910 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
2911 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == CONST_INT)))
2912 fputs ("i", file);
2914 break;
2916 case 'L':
2917 /* Print the lower register of a double word register pair */
2918 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
2919 fputs (reg_names[ REGNO (x)+1 ], file);
2920 else
2921 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'L' modifier:", x);
2922 break;
2924 /* case 'l': print a LABEL_REF. */
2926 case 'M':
2927 case 'N':
2928 /* Print a memory reference for ld/st/jmp, %N prints a memory reference
2929 for the second word of double memory operations. */
2930 offset = (code == 'M') ? 0 : UNITS_PER_WORD;
2931 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2933 default:
2934 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'M/N' modifier:", x);
2936 case MEM:
2937 frv_print_operand_memory_reference (file, XEXP (x, 0), offset);
2938 break;
2940 case REG:
2941 case SUBREG:
2942 case CONST_INT:
2943 case PLUS:
2944 case SYMBOL_REF:
2945 frv_print_operand_memory_reference (file, x, offset);
2946 break;
2948 break;
2950 case 'O':
2951 /* Print the opcode of a command. */
2952 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2954 default:
2955 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'O' modifier:", x);
2957 case PLUS: fputs ("add", file); break;
2958 case MINUS: fputs ("sub", file); break;
2959 case AND: fputs ("and", file); break;
2960 case IOR: fputs ("or", file); break;
2961 case XOR: fputs ("xor", file); break;
2962 case ASHIFT: fputs ("sll", file); break;
2963 case ASHIFTRT: fputs ("sra", file); break;
2964 case LSHIFTRT: fputs ("srl", file); break;
2966 break;
2968 /* case 'n': negate and print a constant int. */
2970 case 'P':
2971 /* Print PIC label using operand as the number. */
2972 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT)
2973 fatal_insn ("bad insn to frv_print_operand, P modifier:", x);
2975 fprintf (file, ".LCF%ld", (long)INTVAL (x));
2976 break;
2978 case 'U':
2979 /* Print 'u' if the operand is a update load/store. */
2980 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PRE_MODIFY)
2981 fputs ("u", file);
2982 break;
2984 case 'z':
2985 /* If value is 0, print gr0, otherwise it must be a register. */
2986 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (x) == 0)
2987 fputs (reg_names[GPR_R0], file);
2989 else if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
2990 fputs (reg_names [REGNO (x)], file);
2992 else
2993 fatal_insn ("bad insn in frv_print_operand, z case", x);
2994 break;
2996 case 'x':
2997 /* Print constant in hex. */
2998 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT || GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
3000 fprintf (file, "%s0x%.4lx", IMMEDIATE_PREFIX, (long) value);
3001 break;
3004 /* Fall through. */
3006 case '\0':
3007 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
3008 fputs (reg_names [REGNO (x)], file);
3010 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT
3011 || GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
3012 fprintf (file, "%s%ld", IMMEDIATE_PREFIX, (long) value);
3014 else if (frv_const_unspec_p (x, &unspec))
3015 frv_output_const_unspec (file, &unspec);
3017 else if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
3018 frv_print_operand_address (file, XEXP (x, 0));
3020 else if (CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (x))
3021 frv_print_operand_address (file, x);
3023 else
3024 fatal_insn ("bad insn in frv_print_operand, 0 case", x);
3026 break;
3028 default:
3029 fatal_insn ("frv_print_operand: unknown code", x);
3030 break;
3033 return;
3036 static bool
3037 frv_print_operand_punct_valid_p (unsigned char code)
3039 return (code == '.' || code == '#' || code == '@' || code == '~'
3040 || code == '*' || code == '&');
3044 /* A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable CUM for the
3045 state at the beginning of the argument list. The variable has type
3046 `CUMULATIVE_ARGS'. The value of FNTYPE is the tree node for the data type
3047 of the function which will receive the args, or 0 if the args are to a
3048 compiler support library function. The value of INDIRECT is nonzero when
3049 processing an indirect call, for example a call through a function pointer.
3050 The value of INDIRECT is zero for a call to an explicitly named function, a
3051 library function call, or when `INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS' is used to find
3052 arguments for the function being compiled.
3054 When processing a call to a compiler support library function, LIBNAME
3055 identifies which one. It is a `symbol_ref' rtx which contains the name of
3056 the function, as a string. LIBNAME is 0 when an ordinary C function call is
3057 being processed. Thus, each time this macro is called, either LIBNAME or
3058 FNTYPE is nonzero, but never both of them at once. */
3060 void
3061 frv_init_cumulative_args (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum,
3062 tree fntype,
3063 rtx libname,
3064 tree fndecl,
3065 int incoming)
3067 *cum = FIRST_ARG_REGNUM;
3069 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
3071 fprintf (stderr, "\ninit_cumulative_args:");
3072 if (!fndecl && fntype)
3073 fputs (" indirect", stderr);
3075 if (incoming)
3076 fputs (" incoming", stderr);
3078 if (fntype)
3080 tree ret_type = TREE_TYPE (fntype);
3081 fprintf (stderr, " return=%s,",
3082 get_tree_code_name (TREE_CODE (ret_type)));
3085 if (libname && GET_CODE (libname) == SYMBOL_REF)
3086 fprintf (stderr, " libname=%s", XSTR (libname, 0));
3088 if (cfun->returns_struct)
3089 fprintf (stderr, " return-struct");
3091 putc ('\n', stderr);
3096 /* Return true if we should pass an argument on the stack rather than
3097 in registers. */
3099 static bool
3100 frv_must_pass_in_stack (enum machine_mode mode, const_tree type)
3102 if (mode == BLKmode)
3103 return true;
3104 if (type == NULL)
3105 return false;
3106 return AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type);
3109 /* If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits, of an
3110 argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
3111 `PARM_BOUNDARY' is used for all arguments. */
3113 static unsigned int
3114 frv_function_arg_boundary (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3115 const_tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3117 return BITS_PER_WORD;
3120 static rtx
3121 frv_function_arg_1 (cumulative_args_t cum_v, enum machine_mode mode,
3122 const_tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, bool named,
3123 bool incoming ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3125 const CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v);
3127 enum machine_mode xmode = (mode == BLKmode) ? SImode : mode;
3128 int arg_num = *cum;
3129 rtx ret;
3130 const char *debstr;
3132 /* Return a marker for use in the call instruction. */
3133 if (xmode == VOIDmode)
3135 ret = const0_rtx;
3136 debstr = "<0>";
3139 else if (arg_num <= LAST_ARG_REGNUM)
3141 ret = gen_rtx_REG (xmode, arg_num);
3142 debstr = reg_names[arg_num];
3145 else
3147 ret = NULL_RTX;
3148 debstr = "memory";
3151 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
3152 fprintf (stderr,
3153 "function_arg: words = %2d, mode = %4s, named = %d, size = %3d, arg = %s\n",
3154 arg_num, GET_MODE_NAME (mode), named, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), debstr);
3156 return ret;
3159 static rtx
3160 frv_function_arg (cumulative_args_t cum, enum machine_mode mode,
3161 const_tree type, bool named)
3163 return frv_function_arg_1 (cum, mode, type, named, false);
3166 static rtx
3167 frv_function_incoming_arg (cumulative_args_t cum, enum machine_mode mode,
3168 const_tree type, bool named)
3170 return frv_function_arg_1 (cum, mode, type, named, true);
3174 /* A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable CUM to
3175 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values MODE, TYPE and
3176 NAMED describe that argument. Once this is done, the variable CUM is
3177 suitable for analyzing the *following* argument with `FUNCTION_ARG', etc.
3179 This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed on
3180 the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space used
3181 for arguments without any special help. */
3183 static void
3184 frv_function_arg_advance (cumulative_args_t cum_v,
3185 enum machine_mode mode,
3186 const_tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3187 bool named)
3189 CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v);
3191 enum machine_mode xmode = (mode == BLKmode) ? SImode : mode;
3192 int bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (xmode);
3193 int words = (bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3194 int arg_num = *cum;
3196 *cum = arg_num + words;
3198 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
3199 fprintf (stderr,
3200 "function_adv: words = %2d, mode = %4s, named = %d, size = %3d\n",
3201 arg_num, GET_MODE_NAME (mode), named, words * UNITS_PER_WORD);
3205 /* A C expression for the number of words, at the beginning of an argument,
3206 must be put in registers. The value must be zero for arguments that are
3207 passed entirely in registers or that are entirely pushed on the stack.
3209 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in registers
3210 and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the first N words of
3211 arguments are passed in registers, and the rest on the stack. If a
3212 multi-word argument (a `double' or a structure) crosses that boundary, its
3213 first few words must be passed in registers and the rest must be pushed.
3214 This macro tells the compiler when this occurs, and how many of the words
3215 should go in registers.
3217 `FUNCTION_ARG' for these arguments should return the first register to be
3218 used by the caller for this argument; likewise `FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG', for
3219 the called function. */
3221 static int
3222 frv_arg_partial_bytes (cumulative_args_t cum, enum machine_mode mode,
3223 tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3226 enum machine_mode xmode = (mode == BLKmode) ? SImode : mode;
3227 int bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (xmode);
3228 int words = (bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3229 int arg_num = *get_cumulative_args (cum);
3230 int ret;
3232 ret = ((arg_num <= LAST_ARG_REGNUM && arg_num + words > LAST_ARG_REGNUM+1)
3233 ? LAST_ARG_REGNUM - arg_num + 1
3234 : 0);
3235 ret *= UNITS_PER_WORD;
3237 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG && ret)
3238 fprintf (stderr, "frv_arg_partial_bytes: %d\n", ret);
3240 return ret;
3244 /* Implements TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE. */
3246 static rtx
3247 frv_function_value (const_tree valtype,
3248 const_tree fn_decl_or_type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3249 bool outgoing ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3251 return gen_rtx_REG (TYPE_MODE (valtype), RETURN_VALUE_REGNUM);
3255 /* Implements TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE. */
3257 static rtx
3258 frv_libcall_value (enum machine_mode mode,
3259 const_rtx fun ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3261 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, RETURN_VALUE_REGNUM);
3265 /* Implements FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P. */
3267 bool
3268 frv_function_value_regno_p (const unsigned int regno)
3270 return (regno == RETURN_VALUE_REGNUM);
3273 /* Return true if a register is ok to use as a base or index register. */
3275 static FRV_INLINE int
3276 frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (int regno, int strict_p)
3278 if (GPR_P (regno))
3279 return TRUE;
3281 if (strict_p)
3282 return (reg_renumber[regno] >= 0 && GPR_P (reg_renumber[regno]));
3284 if (regno == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
3285 return TRUE;
3287 return (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
3291 /* A C compound statement with a conditional `goto LABEL;' executed if X (an
3292 RTX) is a legitimate memory address on the target machine for a memory
3293 operand of mode MODE.
3295 It usually pays to define several simpler macros to serve as subroutines for
3296 this one. Otherwise it may be too complicated to understand.
3298 This macro must exist in two variants: a strict variant and a non-strict
3299 one. The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
3300 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
3301 considered a memory reference. In contexts where some kind of register is
3302 required, a pseudo-register with no hard register must be rejected.
3304 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
3305 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of register is
3306 required.
3308 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this macro
3309 define the macro `REG_OK_STRICT'. You should use an `#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT'
3310 conditional to define the strict variant in that case and the non-strict
3311 variant otherwise.
3313 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a `symbol_ref' and an
3314 integer are stored inside a `const' RTX to mark them as constant.
3315 Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums specifically as
3316 legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply recognize any `const' as
3317 legitimate.
3319 Usually `TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS' is not prepared to handle
3320 constant sums that are not marked with `const'. It assumes that a
3321 naked `plus' indicates indexing. If so, then you *must* reject such
3322 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them
3323 will be given to `TARGET_PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS'. */
3326 frv_legitimate_address_p_1 (enum machine_mode mode,
3327 rtx x,
3328 int strict_p,
3329 int condexec_p,
3330 int allow_double_reg_p)
3332 rtx x0, x1;
3333 int ret = 0;
3334 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
3335 unsigned regno0;
3337 if (FRV_SYMBOL_REF_TLS_P (x))
3338 return 0;
3340 switch (GET_CODE (x))
3342 default:
3343 break;
3345 case SUBREG:
3346 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
3347 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
3348 break;
3350 /* Fall through. */
3352 case REG:
3353 ret = frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (x), strict_p);
3354 break;
3356 case PRE_MODIFY:
3357 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
3358 x1 = XEXP (x, 1);
3359 if (GET_CODE (x0) != REG
3360 || ! frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (x0), strict_p)
3361 || GET_CODE (x1) != PLUS
3362 || ! rtx_equal_p (x0, XEXP (x1, 0))
3363 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x1, 1)) != REG
3364 || ! frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (XEXP (x1, 1)), strict_p))
3365 break;
3367 ret = 1;
3368 break;
3370 case CONST_INT:
3371 /* 12-bit immediate */
3372 if (condexec_p)
3373 ret = FALSE;
3374 else
3376 ret = IN_RANGE (INTVAL (x), -2048, 2047);
3378 /* If we can't use load/store double operations, make sure we can
3379 address the second word. */
3380 if (ret && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
3381 ret = IN_RANGE (INTVAL (x) + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1,
3382 -2048, 2047);
3384 break;
3386 case PLUS:
3387 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
3388 x1 = XEXP (x, 1);
3390 if (GET_CODE (x0) == SUBREG)
3391 x0 = SUBREG_REG (x0);
3393 if (GET_CODE (x0) != REG)
3394 break;
3396 regno0 = REGNO (x0);
3397 if (!frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (regno0, strict_p))
3398 break;
3400 switch (GET_CODE (x1))
3402 default:
3403 break;
3405 case SUBREG:
3406 x1 = SUBREG_REG (x1);
3407 if (GET_CODE (x1) != REG)
3408 break;
3410 /* Fall through. */
3412 case REG:
3413 /* Do not allow reg+reg addressing for modes > 1 word if we
3414 can't depend on having move double instructions. */
3415 if (!allow_double_reg_p && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
3416 ret = FALSE;
3417 else
3418 ret = frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (x1), strict_p);
3419 break;
3421 case CONST_INT:
3422 /* 12-bit immediate */
3423 if (condexec_p)
3424 ret = FALSE;
3425 else
3427 value = INTVAL (x1);
3428 ret = IN_RANGE (value, -2048, 2047);
3430 /* If we can't use load/store double operations, make sure we can
3431 address the second word. */
3432 if (ret && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
3433 ret = IN_RANGE (value + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1, -2048, 2047);
3435 break;
3437 case CONST:
3438 if (!condexec_p && got12_operand (x1, VOIDmode))
3439 ret = TRUE;
3440 break;
3443 break;
3446 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ADDR)
3448 fprintf (stderr, "\n========== legitimate_address_p, mode = %s, result = %d, addresses are %sstrict%s\n",
3449 GET_MODE_NAME (mode), ret, (strict_p) ? "" : "not ",
3450 (condexec_p) ? ", inside conditional code" : "");
3451 debug_rtx (x);
3454 return ret;
3457 bool
3458 frv_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, bool strict_p)
3460 return frv_legitimate_address_p_1 (mode, x, strict_p, FALSE, FALSE);
3463 /* Given an ADDR, generate code to inline the PLT. */
3464 static rtx
3465 gen_inlined_tls_plt (rtx addr)
3467 rtx retval, dest;
3468 rtx picreg = get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, FDPIC_REG);
3471 dest = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3473 if (flag_pic == 1)
3476 -fpic version:
3478 lddi.p @(gr15, #gottlsdesc12(ADDR)), gr8
3479 calll #gettlsoff(ADDR)@(gr8, gr0)
3481 emit_insn (gen_tls_lddi (dest, addr, picreg));
3483 else
3486 -fPIC version:
3488 sethi.p #gottlsdeschi(ADDR), gr8
3489 setlo #gottlsdesclo(ADDR), gr8
3490 ldd #tlsdesc(ADDR)@(gr15, gr8), gr8
3491 calll #gettlsoff(ADDR)@(gr8, gr0)
3493 rtx reguse = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3494 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (reguse, addr, GEN_INT (R_FRV_GOTTLSDESCHI)));
3495 emit_insn (gen_tls_tlsdesc_ldd (dest, picreg, reguse, addr));
3498 retval = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3499 emit_insn (gen_tls_indirect_call (retval, addr, dest, picreg));
3500 return retval;
3503 /* Emit a TLSMOFF or TLSMOFF12 offset, depending on -mTLS. Returns
3504 the destination address. */
3505 static rtx
3506 gen_tlsmoff (rtx addr, rtx reg)
3508 rtx dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3510 if (TARGET_BIG_TLS)
3512 /* sethi.p #tlsmoffhi(x), grA
3513 setlo #tlsmofflo(x), grA
3515 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3516 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (dest, addr,
3517 GEN_INT (R_FRV_TLSMOFFHI)));
3518 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, dest, reg);
3520 else
3522 /* addi grB, #tlsmoff12(x), grC
3523 -or-
3524 ld/st @(grB, #tlsmoff12(x)), grC
3526 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3527 emit_insn (gen_symGOTOFF2reg_i (dest, addr, reg,
3528 GEN_INT (R_FRV_TLSMOFF12)));
3530 return dest;
3533 /* Generate code for a TLS address. */
3534 static rtx
3535 frv_legitimize_tls_address (rtx addr, enum tls_model model)
3537 rtx dest, tp = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 29);
3538 rtx picreg = get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, 15);
3540 switch (model)
3542 case TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC:
3543 if (flag_pic == 1)
3545 /* -fpic version.
3546 ldi @(gr15, #gottlsoff12(x)), gr5
3548 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3549 emit_insn (gen_tls_load_gottlsoff12 (dest, addr, picreg));
3550 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tp, dest);
3552 else
3554 /* -fPIC or anything else.
3556 sethi.p #gottlsoffhi(x), gr14
3557 setlo #gottlsofflo(x), gr14
3558 ld #tlsoff(x)@(gr15, gr14), gr9
3560 rtx tmp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3561 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3562 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (tmp, addr,
3563 GEN_INT (R_FRV_GOTTLSOFF_HI)));
3565 emit_insn (gen_tls_tlsoff_ld (dest, picreg, tmp, addr));
3566 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tp, dest);
3568 break;
3569 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC:
3571 rtx reg, retval;
3573 if (TARGET_INLINE_PLT)
3574 retval = gen_inlined_tls_plt (GEN_INT (0));
3575 else
3577 /* call #gettlsoff(0) */
3578 retval = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3579 emit_insn (gen_call_gettlsoff (retval, GEN_INT (0), picreg));
3582 reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3583 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg,
3584 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
3585 retval, tp)));
3587 dest = gen_tlsmoff (addr, reg);
3590 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3591 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (dest, addr,
3592 GEN_INT (R_FRV_TLSMOFFHI)));
3593 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, dest, reg);
3595 break;
3597 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC:
3598 dest = gen_tlsmoff (addr, gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 29));
3599 break;
3600 case TLS_MODEL_GLOBAL_DYNAMIC:
3602 rtx retval;
3604 if (TARGET_INLINE_PLT)
3605 retval = gen_inlined_tls_plt (addr);
3606 else
3608 /* call #gettlsoff(x) */
3609 retval = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3610 emit_insn (gen_call_gettlsoff (retval, addr, picreg));
3612 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, retval, tp);
3613 break;
3615 default:
3616 gcc_unreachable ();
3619 return dest;
3623 frv_legitimize_address (rtx x,
3624 rtx oldx ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3625 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3627 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF)
3629 enum tls_model model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (x);
3630 if (model != 0)
3631 return frv_legitimize_tls_address (x, model);
3634 return x;
3637 /* Test whether a local function descriptor is canonical, i.e.,
3638 whether we can use FUNCDESC_GOTOFF to compute the address of the
3639 function. */
3641 static bool
3642 frv_local_funcdesc_p (rtx fnx)
3644 tree fn;
3645 enum symbol_visibility vis;
3646 bool ret;
3648 if (! SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (fnx))
3649 return FALSE;
3651 fn = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (fnx);
3653 if (! fn)
3654 return FALSE;
3656 vis = DECL_VISIBILITY (fn);
3658 if (vis == VISIBILITY_PROTECTED)
3659 /* Private function descriptors for protected functions are not
3660 canonical. Temporarily change the visibility to global. */
3661 vis = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
3662 else if (flag_shlib)
3663 /* If we're already compiling for a shared library (that, unlike
3664 executables, can't assume that the existence of a definition
3665 implies local binding), we can skip the re-testing. */
3666 return TRUE;
3668 ret = default_binds_local_p_1 (fn, flag_pic);
3670 DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = vis;
3672 return ret;
3675 /* Load the _gp symbol into DEST. SRC is supposed to be the FDPIC
3676 register. */
3679 frv_gen_GPsym2reg (rtx dest, rtx src)
3681 tree gp = get_identifier ("_gp");
3682 rtx gp_sym = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (gp));
3684 return gen_symGOT2reg (dest, gp_sym, src, GEN_INT (R_FRV_GOT12));
3687 static const char *
3688 unspec_got_name (int i)
3690 switch (i)
3692 case R_FRV_GOT12: return "got12";
3693 case R_FRV_GOTHI: return "gothi";
3694 case R_FRV_GOTLO: return "gotlo";
3695 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC: return "funcdesc";
3696 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOT12: return "gotfuncdesc12";
3697 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTHI: return "gotfuncdeschi";
3698 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTLO: return "gotfuncdesclo";
3699 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_VALUE: return "funcdescvalue";
3700 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12: return "gotofffuncdesc12";
3701 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFFHI: return "gotofffuncdeschi";
3702 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFFLO: return "gotofffuncdesclo";
3703 case R_FRV_GOTOFF12: return "gotoff12";
3704 case R_FRV_GOTOFFHI: return "gotoffhi";
3705 case R_FRV_GOTOFFLO: return "gotofflo";
3706 case R_FRV_GPREL12: return "gprel12";
3707 case R_FRV_GPRELHI: return "gprelhi";
3708 case R_FRV_GPRELLO: return "gprello";
3709 case R_FRV_GOTTLSOFF_HI: return "gottlsoffhi";
3710 case R_FRV_GOTTLSOFF_LO: return "gottlsofflo";
3711 case R_FRV_TLSMOFFHI: return "tlsmoffhi";
3712 case R_FRV_TLSMOFFLO: return "tlsmofflo";
3713 case R_FRV_TLSMOFF12: return "tlsmoff12";
3714 case R_FRV_TLSDESCHI: return "tlsdeschi";
3715 case R_FRV_TLSDESCLO: return "tlsdesclo";
3716 case R_FRV_GOTTLSDESCHI: return "gottlsdeschi";
3717 case R_FRV_GOTTLSDESCLO: return "gottlsdesclo";
3718 default: gcc_unreachable ();
3722 /* Write the assembler syntax for UNSPEC to STREAM. Note that any offset
3723 is added inside the relocation operator. */
3725 static void
3726 frv_output_const_unspec (FILE *stream, const struct frv_unspec *unspec)
3728 fprintf (stream, "#%s(", unspec_got_name (unspec->reloc));
3729 output_addr_const (stream, plus_constant (Pmode, unspec->symbol,
3730 unspec->offset));
3731 fputs (")", stream);
3734 /* Implement FIND_BASE_TERM. See whether ORIG_X represents #gprel12(foo)
3735 or #gotoff12(foo) for some small data symbol foo. If so, return foo,
3736 otherwise return ORIG_X. */
3739 frv_find_base_term (rtx x)
3741 struct frv_unspec unspec;
3743 if (frv_const_unspec_p (x, &unspec)
3744 && frv_small_data_reloc_p (unspec.symbol, unspec.reloc))
3745 return plus_constant (Pmode, unspec.symbol, unspec.offset);
3747 return x;
3750 /* Return 1 if operand is a valid FRV address. CONDEXEC_P is true if
3751 the operand is used by a predicated instruction. */
3754 frv_legitimate_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode, int condexec_p)
3756 return ((GET_MODE (op) == mode || mode == VOIDmode)
3757 && GET_CODE (op) == MEM
3758 && frv_legitimate_address_p_1 (mode, XEXP (op, 0),
3759 reload_completed, condexec_p, FALSE));
3762 void
3763 frv_expand_fdpic_call (rtx *operands, bool ret_value, bool sibcall)
3765 rtx lr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO);
3766 rtx picreg = get_hard_reg_initial_val (SImode, FDPIC_REG);
3767 rtx c, rvrtx=0;
3768 rtx addr;
3770 if (ret_value)
3772 rvrtx = operands[0];
3773 operands ++;
3776 addr = XEXP (operands[0], 0);
3778 /* Inline PLTs if we're optimizing for speed. We'd like to inline
3779 any calls that would involve a PLT, but can't tell, since we
3780 don't know whether an extern function is going to be provided by
3781 a separate translation unit or imported from a separate module.
3782 When compiling for shared libraries, if the function has default
3783 visibility, we assume it's overridable, so we inline the PLT, but
3784 for executables, we don't really have a way to make a good
3785 decision: a function is as likely to be imported from a shared
3786 library as it is to be defined in the executable itself. We
3787 assume executables will get global functions defined locally,
3788 whereas shared libraries will have them potentially overridden,
3789 so we only inline PLTs when compiling for shared libraries.
3791 In order to mark a function as local to a shared library, any
3792 non-default visibility attribute suffices. Unfortunately,
3793 there's no simple way to tag a function declaration as ``in a
3794 different module'', which we could then use to trigger PLT
3795 inlining on executables. There's -minline-plt, but it affects
3796 all external functions, so one would have to also mark function
3797 declarations available in the same module with non-default
3798 visibility, which is advantageous in itself. */
3799 if (GET_CODE (addr) == SYMBOL_REF
3800 && ((!SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (addr) && TARGET_INLINE_PLT)
3801 || sibcall))
3803 rtx x, dest;
3804 dest = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
3805 if (flag_pic != 1)
3806 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, addr, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
3807 GEN_INT (R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12));
3808 else
3809 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, addr, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
3810 GEN_INT (R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12));
3811 emit_insn (x);
3812 crtl->uses_pic_offset_table = TRUE;
3813 addr = dest;
3815 else if (GET_CODE (addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
3817 /* These are always either local, or handled through a local
3818 PLT. */
3819 if (ret_value)
3820 c = gen_call_value_fdpicsi (rvrtx, addr, operands[1],
3821 operands[2], picreg, lr);
3822 else
3823 c = gen_call_fdpicsi (addr, operands[1], operands[2], picreg, lr);
3824 emit_call_insn (c);
3825 return;
3827 else if (! ldd_address_operand (addr, Pmode))
3828 addr = force_reg (Pmode, addr);
3830 picreg = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3831 emit_insn (gen_movdi_ldd (picreg, addr));
3833 if (sibcall && ret_value)
3834 c = gen_sibcall_value_fdpicdi (rvrtx, picreg, const0_rtx);
3835 else if (sibcall)
3836 c = gen_sibcall_fdpicdi (picreg, const0_rtx);
3837 else if (ret_value)
3838 c = gen_call_value_fdpicdi (rvrtx, picreg, const0_rtx, lr);
3839 else
3840 c = gen_call_fdpicdi (picreg, const0_rtx, lr);
3841 emit_call_insn (c);
3844 /* Look for a SYMBOL_REF of a function in an rtx. We always want to
3845 process these separately from any offsets, such that we add any
3846 offsets to the function descriptor (the actual pointer), not to the
3847 function address. */
3849 static bool
3850 frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (rtx x)
3852 const char *format;
3853 int length;
3854 int j;
3856 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF)
3857 return SYMBOL_REF_FUNCTION_P (x);
3859 length = GET_RTX_LENGTH (GET_CODE (x));
3860 format = GET_RTX_FORMAT (GET_CODE (x));
3862 for (j = 0; j < length; ++j)
3864 switch (format[j])
3866 case 'e':
3867 if (frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (XEXP (x, j)))
3868 return TRUE;
3869 break;
3871 case 'V':
3872 case 'E':
3873 if (XVEC (x, j) != 0)
3875 int k;
3876 for (k = 0; k < XVECLEN (x, j); ++k)
3877 if (frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (XVECEXP (x, j, k)))
3878 return TRUE;
3880 break;
3882 default:
3883 /* Nothing to do. */
3884 break;
3888 return FALSE;
3891 /* Return true if the memory operand is one that can be conditionally
3892 executed. */
3895 condexec_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
3897 enum machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (op);
3898 rtx addr;
3900 if (mode != VOIDmode && op_mode != mode)
3901 return FALSE;
3903 switch (op_mode)
3905 default:
3906 return FALSE;
3908 case QImode:
3909 case HImode:
3910 case SImode:
3911 case SFmode:
3912 break;
3915 if (GET_CODE (op) != MEM)
3916 return FALSE;
3918 addr = XEXP (op, 0);
3919 return frv_legitimate_address_p_1 (mode, addr, reload_completed, TRUE, FALSE);
3922 /* Return true if the bare return instruction can be used outside of the
3923 epilog code. For frv, we only do it if there was no stack allocation. */
3926 direct_return_p (void)
3928 frv_stack_t *info;
3930 if (!reload_completed)
3931 return FALSE;
3933 info = frv_stack_info ();
3934 return (info->total_size == 0);
3938 void
3939 frv_emit_move (enum machine_mode mode, rtx dest, rtx src)
3941 if (GET_CODE (src) == SYMBOL_REF)
3943 enum tls_model model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (src);
3944 if (model != 0)
3945 src = frv_legitimize_tls_address (src, model);
3948 switch (mode)
3950 case SImode:
3951 if (frv_emit_movsi (dest, src))
3952 return;
3953 break;
3955 case QImode:
3956 case HImode:
3957 case DImode:
3958 case SFmode:
3959 case DFmode:
3960 if (!reload_in_progress
3961 && !reload_completed
3962 && !register_operand (dest, mode)
3963 && !reg_or_0_operand (src, mode))
3964 src = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, src);
3965 break;
3967 default:
3968 gcc_unreachable ();
3971 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src));
3974 /* Emit code to handle a MOVSI, adding in the small data register or pic
3975 register if needed to load up addresses. Return TRUE if the appropriate
3976 instructions are emitted. */
3979 frv_emit_movsi (rtx dest, rtx src)
3981 int base_regno = -1;
3982 int unspec = 0;
3983 rtx sym = src;
3984 struct frv_unspec old_unspec;
3986 if (!reload_in_progress
3987 && !reload_completed
3988 && !register_operand (dest, SImode)
3989 && (!reg_or_0_operand (src, SImode)
3990 /* Virtual registers will almost always be replaced by an
3991 add instruction, so expose this to CSE by copying to
3992 an intermediate register. */
3993 || (GET_CODE (src) == REG
3994 && IN_RANGE (REGNO (src),
3995 FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER,
3996 LAST_VIRTUAL_POINTER_REGISTER))))
3998 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, copy_to_mode_reg (SImode, src)));
3999 return TRUE;
4002 /* Explicitly add in the PIC or small data register if needed. */
4003 switch (GET_CODE (src))
4005 default:
4006 break;
4008 case LABEL_REF:
4009 handle_label:
4010 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
4012 /* Using GPREL12, we use a single GOT entry for all symbols
4013 in read-only sections, but trade sequences such as:
4015 sethi #gothi(label), gr#
4016 setlo #gotlo(label), gr#
4017 ld @(gr15,gr#), gr#
4021 ld @(gr15,#got12(_gp)), gr#
4022 sethi #gprelhi(label), gr##
4023 setlo #gprello(label), gr##
4024 add gr#, gr##, gr##
4026 We may often be able to share gr# for multiple
4027 computations of GPREL addresses, and we may often fold
4028 the final add into the pair of registers of a load or
4029 store instruction, so it's often profitable. Even when
4030 optimizing for size, we're trading a GOT entry for an
4031 additional instruction, which trades GOT space
4032 (read-write) for code size (read-only, shareable), as
4033 long as the symbol is not used in more than two different
4034 locations.
4036 With -fpie/-fpic, we'd be trading a single load for a
4037 sequence of 4 instructions, because the offset of the
4038 label can't be assumed to be addressable with 12 bits, so
4039 we don't do this. */
4040 if (TARGET_GPREL_RO)
4041 unspec = R_FRV_GPREL12;
4042 else
4043 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4045 else if (flag_pic)
4046 base_regno = PIC_REGNO;
4048 break;
4050 case CONST:
4051 if (frv_const_unspec_p (src, &old_unspec))
4052 break;
4054 if (TARGET_FDPIC && frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (XEXP (src, 0)))
4056 handle_whatever:
4057 src = force_reg (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)), XEXP (src, 0));
4058 emit_move_insn (dest, src);
4059 return TRUE;
4061 else
4063 sym = XEXP (sym, 0);
4064 if (GET_CODE (sym) == PLUS
4065 && GET_CODE (XEXP (sym, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
4066 && GET_CODE (XEXP (sym, 1)) == CONST_INT)
4067 sym = XEXP (sym, 0);
4068 if (GET_CODE (sym) == SYMBOL_REF)
4069 goto handle_sym;
4070 else if (GET_CODE (sym) == LABEL_REF)
4071 goto handle_label;
4072 else
4073 goto handle_whatever;
4075 break;
4077 case SYMBOL_REF:
4078 handle_sym:
4079 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
4081 enum tls_model model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (sym);
4083 if (model != 0)
4085 src = frv_legitimize_tls_address (src, model);
4086 emit_move_insn (dest, src);
4087 return TRUE;
4090 if (SYMBOL_REF_FUNCTION_P (sym))
4092 if (frv_local_funcdesc_p (sym))
4093 unspec = R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12;
4094 else
4095 unspec = R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOT12;
4097 else
4099 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (sym))
4100 switch (GET_CODE (get_pool_constant (sym)))
4102 case CONST:
4103 case SYMBOL_REF:
4104 case LABEL_REF:
4105 if (flag_pic)
4107 unspec = R_FRV_GOTOFF12;
4108 break;
4110 /* Fall through. */
4111 default:
4112 if (TARGET_GPREL_RO)
4113 unspec = R_FRV_GPREL12;
4114 else
4115 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4116 break;
4118 else if (SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (sym)
4119 && !SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (sym)
4120 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym)
4121 && (!DECL_P (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym))
4122 || !DECL_COMMON (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym))))
4124 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym);
4125 tree init = TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
4126 ? DECL_INITIAL (decl)
4127 : TREE_CODE (decl) == CONSTRUCTOR
4128 ? decl : 0;
4129 int reloc = 0;
4130 bool named_section, readonly;
4132 if (init && init != error_mark_node)
4133 reloc = compute_reloc_for_constant (init);
4135 named_section = TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
4136 && lookup_attribute ("section", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl));
4137 readonly = decl_readonly_section (decl, reloc);
4139 if (named_section)
4140 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4141 else if (!readonly)
4142 unspec = R_FRV_GOTOFF12;
4143 else if (readonly && TARGET_GPREL_RO)
4144 unspec = R_FRV_GPREL12;
4145 else
4146 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4148 else
4149 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4153 else if (SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (sym))
4154 base_regno = SDA_BASE_REG;
4156 else if (flag_pic)
4157 base_regno = PIC_REGNO;
4159 break;
4162 if (base_regno >= 0)
4164 if (GET_CODE (sym) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (sym))
4165 emit_insn (gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, src,
4166 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, base_regno),
4167 GEN_INT (R_FRV_GPREL12)));
4168 else
4169 emit_insn (gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, src,
4170 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, base_regno),
4171 GEN_INT (R_FRV_GPREL12)));
4172 if (base_regno == PIC_REGNO)
4173 crtl->uses_pic_offset_table = TRUE;
4174 return TRUE;
4177 if (unspec)
4179 rtx x;
4181 /* Since OUR_FDPIC_REG is a pseudo register, we can't safely introduce
4182 new uses of it once reload has begun. */
4183 gcc_assert (!reload_in_progress && !reload_completed);
4185 switch (unspec)
4187 case R_FRV_GOTOFF12:
4188 if (!frv_small_data_reloc_p (sym, unspec))
4189 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4190 GEN_INT (unspec));
4191 else
4192 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4193 break;
4194 case R_FRV_GPREL12:
4195 if (!frv_small_data_reloc_p (sym, unspec))
4196 x = gen_symGPREL2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4197 GEN_INT (unspec));
4198 else
4199 x = gen_symGPREL2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4200 break;
4201 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12:
4202 if (flag_pic != 1)
4203 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4204 GEN_INT (unspec));
4205 else
4206 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4207 break;
4208 default:
4209 if (flag_pic != 1)
4210 x = gen_symGOT2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4211 GEN_INT (unspec));
4212 else
4213 x = gen_symGOT2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4214 break;
4216 emit_insn (x);
4217 crtl->uses_pic_offset_table = TRUE;
4218 return TRUE;
4222 return FALSE;
4226 /* Return a string to output a single word move. */
4228 const char *
4229 output_move_single (rtx operands[], rtx insn)
4231 rtx dest = operands[0];
4232 rtx src = operands[1];
4234 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
4236 int dest_regno = REGNO (dest);
4237 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4239 if (GPR_P (dest_regno))
4241 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4243 /* gpr <- some sort of register */
4244 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4246 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4247 return "mov %1, %0";
4249 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4250 return "movfg %1, %0";
4252 else if (SPR_P (src_regno))
4253 return "movsg %1, %0";
4256 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4258 /* gpr <- memory */
4259 switch (mode)
4261 default:
4262 break;
4264 case QImode:
4265 return "ldsb%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4267 case HImode:
4268 return "ldsh%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4270 case SImode:
4271 case SFmode:
4272 return "ld%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4276 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT
4277 || GET_CODE (src) == CONST_DOUBLE)
4279 /* gpr <- integer/floating constant */
4280 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
4282 if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT)
4283 value = INTVAL (src);
4285 else if (mode == SFmode)
4287 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
4288 long l;
4290 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, src);
4291 REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (rv, l);
4292 value = l;
4295 else
4296 value = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (src);
4298 if (IN_RANGE (value, -32768, 32767))
4299 return "setlos %1, %0";
4301 return "#";
4304 else if (GET_CODE (src) == SYMBOL_REF
4305 || GET_CODE (src) == LABEL_REF
4306 || GET_CODE (src) == CONST)
4308 return "#";
4312 else if (FPR_P (dest_regno))
4314 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4316 /* fpr <- some sort of register */
4317 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4319 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4320 return "movgf %1, %0";
4322 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4324 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT)
4325 return "fmovs %1, %0";
4326 else
4327 return "mor %1, %1, %0";
4331 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4333 /* fpr <- memory */
4334 switch (mode)
4336 default:
4337 break;
4339 case QImode:
4340 return "ldbf%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4342 case HImode:
4343 return "ldhf%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4345 case SImode:
4346 case SFmode:
4347 return "ldf%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4351 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4352 return "movgf %., %0";
4355 else if (SPR_P (dest_regno))
4357 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4359 /* spr <- some sort of register */
4360 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4362 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4363 return "movgs %1, %0";
4365 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4366 return "movgs %., %0";
4370 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
4372 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4374 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4375 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4377 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4379 switch (mode)
4381 default:
4382 break;
4384 case QImode:
4385 return "stb%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4387 case HImode:
4388 return "sth%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4390 case SImode:
4391 case SFmode:
4392 return "st%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4396 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4398 switch (mode)
4400 default:
4401 break;
4403 case QImode:
4404 return "stbf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4406 case HImode:
4407 return "sthf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4409 case SImode:
4410 case SFmode:
4411 return "stf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4416 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4418 switch (GET_MODE (dest))
4420 default:
4421 break;
4423 case QImode:
4424 return "stb%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4426 case HImode:
4427 return "sth%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4429 case SImode:
4430 case SFmode:
4431 return "st%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4436 fatal_insn ("bad output_move_single operand", insn);
4437 return "";
4441 /* Return a string to output a double word move. */
4443 const char *
4444 output_move_double (rtx operands[], rtx insn)
4446 rtx dest = operands[0];
4447 rtx src = operands[1];
4448 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4450 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
4452 int dest_regno = REGNO (dest);
4454 if (GPR_P (dest_regno))
4456 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4458 /* gpr <- some sort of register */
4459 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4461 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4462 return "#";
4464 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4466 if (((dest_regno - GPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4467 && ((src_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0)
4468 return "movfgd %1, %0";
4470 return "#";
4474 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4476 /* gpr <- memory */
4477 if (dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (src, mode))
4478 return "ldd%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4480 return "#";
4483 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT
4484 || GET_CODE (src) == CONST_DOUBLE)
4485 return "#";
4488 else if (FPR_P (dest_regno))
4490 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4492 /* fpr <- some sort of register */
4493 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4495 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4497 if (((dest_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4498 && ((src_regno - GPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0)
4499 return "movgfd %1, %0";
4501 return "#";
4504 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4506 if (TARGET_DOUBLE
4507 && ((dest_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4508 && ((src_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0)
4509 return "fmovd %1, %0";
4511 return "#";
4515 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4517 /* fpr <- memory */
4518 if (dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (src, mode))
4519 return "lddf%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4521 return "#";
4524 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4525 return "#";
4529 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
4531 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4533 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4535 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4537 if (((src_regno - GPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4538 && dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (dest, mode))
4539 return "std%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4541 return "#";
4544 if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4546 if (((src_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4547 && dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (dest, mode))
4548 return "stdf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4550 return "#";
4554 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4556 if (dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (dest, mode))
4557 return "std%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4559 return "#";
4563 fatal_insn ("bad output_move_double operand", insn);
4564 return "";
4568 /* Return a string to output a single word conditional move.
4569 Operand0 -- EQ/NE of ccr register and 0
4570 Operand1 -- CCR register
4571 Operand2 -- destination
4572 Operand3 -- source */
4574 const char *
4575 output_condmove_single (rtx operands[], rtx insn)
4577 rtx dest = operands[2];
4578 rtx src = operands[3];
4580 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
4582 int dest_regno = REGNO (dest);
4583 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4585 if (GPR_P (dest_regno))
4587 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4589 /* gpr <- some sort of register */
4590 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4592 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4593 return "cmov %z3, %2, %1, %e0";
4595 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4596 return "cmovfg %3, %2, %1, %e0";
4599 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4601 /* gpr <- memory */
4602 switch (mode)
4604 default:
4605 break;
4607 case QImode:
4608 return "cldsb%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4610 case HImode:
4611 return "cldsh%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4613 case SImode:
4614 case SFmode:
4615 return "cld%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4619 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4620 return "cmov %., %2, %1, %e0";
4623 else if (FPR_P (dest_regno))
4625 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4627 /* fpr <- some sort of register */
4628 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4630 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4631 return "cmovgf %3, %2, %1, %e0";
4633 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4635 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT)
4636 return "cfmovs %3,%2,%1,%e0";
4637 else
4638 return "cmor %3, %3, %2, %1, %e0";
4642 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4644 /* fpr <- memory */
4645 if (mode == SImode || mode == SFmode)
4646 return "cldf%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4649 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4650 return "cmovgf %., %2, %1, %e0";
4654 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
4656 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4658 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4659 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4661 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4663 switch (mode)
4665 default:
4666 break;
4668 case QImode:
4669 return "cstb%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4671 case HImode:
4672 return "csth%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4674 case SImode:
4675 case SFmode:
4676 return "cst%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4680 else if (FPR_P (src_regno) && (mode == SImode || mode == SFmode))
4681 return "cstf%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4684 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4686 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4687 switch (mode)
4689 default:
4690 break;
4692 case QImode:
4693 return "cstb%I2%U2 %., %M2, %1, %e0";
4695 case HImode:
4696 return "csth%I2%U2 %., %M2, %1, %e0";
4698 case SImode:
4699 case SFmode:
4700 return "cst%I2%U2 %., %M2, %1, %e0";
4705 fatal_insn ("bad output_condmove_single operand", insn);
4706 return "";
4710 /* Emit the appropriate code to do a comparison, returning the register the
4711 comparison was done it. */
4713 static rtx
4714 frv_emit_comparison (enum rtx_code test, rtx op0, rtx op1)
4716 enum machine_mode cc_mode;
4717 rtx cc_reg;
4719 /* Floating point doesn't have comparison against a constant. */
4720 if (GET_MODE (op0) == CC_FPmode && GET_CODE (op1) != REG)
4721 op1 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op1);
4723 /* Possibly disable using anything but a fixed register in order to work
4724 around cse moving comparisons past function calls. */
4725 cc_mode = SELECT_CC_MODE (test, op0, op1);
4726 cc_reg = ((TARGET_ALLOC_CC)
4727 ? gen_reg_rtx (cc_mode)
4728 : gen_rtx_REG (cc_mode,
4729 (cc_mode == CC_FPmode) ? FCC_FIRST : ICC_FIRST));
4731 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, cc_reg,
4732 gen_rtx_COMPARE (cc_mode, op0, op1)));
4734 return cc_reg;
4738 /* Emit code for a conditional branch.
4739 XXX: I originally wanted to add a clobber of a CCR register to use in
4740 conditional execution, but that confuses the rest of the compiler. */
4743 frv_emit_cond_branch (rtx operands[])
4745 rtx test_rtx;
4746 rtx label_ref;
4747 rtx if_else;
4748 enum rtx_code test = GET_CODE (operands[0]);
4749 rtx cc_reg = frv_emit_comparison (test, operands[1], operands[2]);
4750 enum machine_mode cc_mode = GET_MODE (cc_reg);
4752 /* Branches generate:
4753 (set (pc)
4754 (if_then_else (<test>, <cc_reg>, (const_int 0))
4755 (label_ref <branch_label>)
4756 (pc))) */
4757 label_ref = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (VOIDmode, operands[3]);
4758 test_rtx = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test, cc_mode, cc_reg, const0_rtx);
4759 if_else = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (cc_mode, test_rtx, label_ref, pc_rtx);
4760 emit_jump_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, pc_rtx, if_else));
4761 return TRUE;
4765 /* Emit code to set a gpr to 1/0 based on a comparison. */
4768 frv_emit_scc (rtx operands[])
4770 rtx set;
4771 rtx test_rtx;
4772 rtx clobber;
4773 rtx cr_reg;
4774 enum rtx_code test = GET_CODE (operands[1]);
4775 rtx cc_reg = frv_emit_comparison (test, operands[2], operands[3]);
4777 /* SCC instructions generate:
4778 (parallel [(set <target> (<test>, <cc_reg>, (const_int 0))
4779 (clobber (<ccr_reg>))]) */
4780 test_rtx = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test, SImode, cc_reg, const0_rtx);
4781 set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, operands[0], test_rtx);
4783 cr_reg = ((TARGET_ALLOC_CC)
4784 ? gen_reg_rtx (CC_CCRmode)
4785 : gen_rtx_REG (CC_CCRmode,
4786 ((GET_MODE (cc_reg) == CC_FPmode)
4787 ? FCR_FIRST
4788 : ICR_FIRST)));
4790 clobber = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, cr_reg);
4791 emit_insn (gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, gen_rtvec (2, set, clobber)));
4792 return TRUE;
4796 /* Split a SCC instruction into component parts, returning a SEQUENCE to hold
4797 the separate insns. */
4800 frv_split_scc (rtx dest, rtx test, rtx cc_reg, rtx cr_reg, HOST_WIDE_INT value)
4802 rtx ret;
4804 start_sequence ();
4806 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
4807 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
4808 cr_reg,
4809 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (test),
4810 GET_MODE (cr_reg),
4811 cc_reg,
4812 const0_rtx)));
4814 /* Move the value into the destination. */
4815 emit_move_insn (dest, GEN_INT (value));
4817 /* Move 0 into the destination if the test failed */
4818 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4819 gen_rtx_EQ (GET_MODE (cr_reg),
4820 cr_reg,
4821 const0_rtx),
4822 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, const0_rtx)));
4824 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
4825 ret = get_insns ();
4826 end_sequence ();
4827 return ret;
4831 /* Emit the code for a conditional move, return TRUE if we could do the
4832 move. */
4835 frv_emit_cond_move (rtx dest, rtx test_rtx, rtx src1, rtx src2)
4837 rtx set;
4838 rtx clobber_cc;
4839 rtx test2;
4840 rtx cr_reg;
4841 rtx if_rtx;
4842 enum rtx_code test = GET_CODE (test_rtx);
4843 rtx cc_reg = frv_emit_comparison (test,
4844 XEXP (test_rtx, 0), XEXP (test_rtx, 1));
4845 enum machine_mode cc_mode = GET_MODE (cc_reg);
4847 /* Conditional move instructions generate:
4848 (parallel [(set <target>
4849 (if_then_else (<test> <cc_reg> (const_int 0))
4850 <src1>
4851 <src2>))
4852 (clobber (<ccr_reg>))]) */
4854 /* Handle various cases of conditional move involving two constants. */
4855 if (GET_CODE (src1) == CONST_INT && GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT)
4857 HOST_WIDE_INT value1 = INTVAL (src1);
4858 HOST_WIDE_INT value2 = INTVAL (src2);
4860 /* Having 0 as one of the constants can be done by loading the other
4861 constant, and optionally moving in gr0. */
4862 if (value1 == 0 || value2 == 0)
4865 /* If the first value is within an addi range and also the difference
4866 between the two fits in an addi's range, load up the difference, then
4867 conditionally move in 0, and then unconditionally add the first
4868 value. */
4869 else if (IN_RANGE (value1, -2048, 2047)
4870 && IN_RANGE (value2 - value1, -2048, 2047))
4873 /* If neither condition holds, just force the constant into a
4874 register. */
4875 else
4877 src1 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src1);
4878 src2 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src2);
4882 /* If one value is a register, insure the other value is either 0 or a
4883 register. */
4884 else
4886 if (GET_CODE (src1) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (src1) != 0)
4887 src1 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src1);
4889 if (GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (src2) != 0)
4890 src2 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src2);
4893 test2 = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test, cc_mode, cc_reg, const0_rtx);
4894 if_rtx = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (GET_MODE (dest), test2, src1, src2);
4896 set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, if_rtx);
4898 cr_reg = ((TARGET_ALLOC_CC)
4899 ? gen_reg_rtx (CC_CCRmode)
4900 : gen_rtx_REG (CC_CCRmode,
4901 (cc_mode == CC_FPmode) ? FCR_FIRST : ICR_FIRST));
4903 clobber_cc = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, cr_reg);
4904 emit_insn (gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, gen_rtvec (2, set, clobber_cc)));
4905 return TRUE;
4909 /* Split a conditional move into constituent parts, returning a SEQUENCE
4910 containing all of the insns. */
4913 frv_split_cond_move (rtx operands[])
4915 rtx dest = operands[0];
4916 rtx test = operands[1];
4917 rtx cc_reg = operands[2];
4918 rtx src1 = operands[3];
4919 rtx src2 = operands[4];
4920 rtx cr_reg = operands[5];
4921 rtx ret;
4922 enum machine_mode cr_mode = GET_MODE (cr_reg);
4924 start_sequence ();
4926 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
4927 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
4928 cr_reg,
4929 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (test),
4930 GET_MODE (cr_reg),
4931 cc_reg,
4932 const0_rtx)));
4934 /* Handle various cases of conditional move involving two constants. */
4935 if (GET_CODE (src1) == CONST_INT && GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT)
4937 HOST_WIDE_INT value1 = INTVAL (src1);
4938 HOST_WIDE_INT value2 = INTVAL (src2);
4940 /* Having 0 as one of the constants can be done by loading the other
4941 constant, and optionally moving in gr0. */
4942 if (value1 == 0)
4944 emit_move_insn (dest, src2);
4945 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4946 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg,
4947 const0_rtx),
4948 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
4951 else if (value2 == 0)
4953 emit_move_insn (dest, src1);
4954 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4955 gen_rtx_EQ (cr_mode, cr_reg,
4956 const0_rtx),
4957 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src2)));
4960 /* If the first value is within an addi range and also the difference
4961 between the two fits in an addi's range, load up the difference, then
4962 conditionally move in 0, and then unconditionally add the first
4963 value. */
4964 else if (IN_RANGE (value1, -2048, 2047)
4965 && IN_RANGE (value2 - value1, -2048, 2047))
4967 rtx dest_si = ((GET_MODE (dest) == SImode)
4968 ? dest
4969 : gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, dest, 0));
4971 emit_move_insn (dest_si, GEN_INT (value2 - value1));
4972 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4973 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg,
4974 const0_rtx),
4975 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest_si,
4976 const0_rtx)));
4977 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (dest_si, dest_si, src1));
4980 else
4981 gcc_unreachable ();
4983 else
4985 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being true if needed. */
4986 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src1))
4987 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4988 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
4989 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
4991 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being false if needed. */
4992 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src2))
4993 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4994 gen_rtx_EQ (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
4995 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src2)));
4998 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
4999 ret = get_insns ();
5000 end_sequence ();
5001 return ret;
5005 /* Split (set DEST SOURCE), where DEST is a double register and SOURCE is a
5006 memory location that is not known to be dword-aligned. */
5007 void
5008 frv_split_double_load (rtx dest, rtx source)
5010 int regno = REGNO (dest);
5011 rtx dest1 = gen_highpart (SImode, dest);
5012 rtx dest2 = gen_lowpart (SImode, dest);
5013 rtx address = XEXP (source, 0);
5015 /* If the address is pre-modified, load the lower-numbered register
5016 first, then load the other register using an integer offset from
5017 the modified base register. This order should always be safe,
5018 since the pre-modification cannot affect the same registers as the
5019 load does.
5021 The situation for other loads is more complicated. Loading one
5022 of the registers could affect the value of ADDRESS, so we must
5023 be careful which order we do them in. */
5024 if (GET_CODE (address) == PRE_MODIFY
5025 || ! refers_to_regno_p (regno, regno + 1, address, NULL))
5027 /* It is safe to load the lower-numbered register first. */
5028 emit_move_insn (dest1, change_address (source, SImode, NULL));
5029 emit_move_insn (dest2, frv_index_memory (source, SImode, 1));
5031 else
5033 /* ADDRESS is not pre-modified and the address depends on the
5034 lower-numbered register. Load the higher-numbered register
5035 first. */
5036 emit_move_insn (dest2, frv_index_memory (source, SImode, 1));
5037 emit_move_insn (dest1, change_address (source, SImode, NULL));
5041 /* Split (set DEST SOURCE), where DEST refers to a dword memory location
5042 and SOURCE is either a double register or the constant zero. */
5043 void
5044 frv_split_double_store (rtx dest, rtx source)
5046 rtx dest1 = change_address (dest, SImode, NULL);
5047 rtx dest2 = frv_index_memory (dest, SImode, 1);
5048 if (ZERO_P (source))
5050 emit_move_insn (dest1, CONST0_RTX (SImode));
5051 emit_move_insn (dest2, CONST0_RTX (SImode));
5053 else
5055 emit_move_insn (dest1, gen_highpart (SImode, source));
5056 emit_move_insn (dest2, gen_lowpart (SImode, source));
5061 /* Split a min/max operation returning a SEQUENCE containing all of the
5062 insns. */
5065 frv_split_minmax (rtx operands[])
5067 rtx dest = operands[0];
5068 rtx minmax = operands[1];
5069 rtx src1 = operands[2];
5070 rtx src2 = operands[3];
5071 rtx cc_reg = operands[4];
5072 rtx cr_reg = operands[5];
5073 rtx ret;
5074 enum rtx_code test_code;
5075 enum machine_mode cr_mode = GET_MODE (cr_reg);
5077 start_sequence ();
5079 /* Figure out which test to use. */
5080 switch (GET_CODE (minmax))
5082 default:
5083 gcc_unreachable ();
5085 case SMIN: test_code = LT; break;
5086 case SMAX: test_code = GT; break;
5087 case UMIN: test_code = LTU; break;
5088 case UMAX: test_code = GTU; break;
5091 /* Issue the compare instruction. */
5092 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5093 cc_reg,
5094 gen_rtx_COMPARE (GET_MODE (cc_reg),
5095 src1, src2)));
5097 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
5098 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5099 cr_reg,
5100 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test_code,
5101 GET_MODE (cr_reg),
5102 cc_reg,
5103 const0_rtx)));
5105 /* If are taking the min/max of a nonzero constant, load that first, and
5106 then do a conditional move of the other value. */
5107 if (GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (src2) != 0)
5109 gcc_assert (!rtx_equal_p (dest, src1));
5111 emit_move_insn (dest, src2);
5112 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5113 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5114 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
5117 /* Otherwise, do each half of the move. */
5118 else
5120 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being true if needed. */
5121 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src1))
5122 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5123 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5124 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
5126 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being false if needed. */
5127 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src2))
5128 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5129 gen_rtx_EQ (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5130 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src2)));
5133 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
5134 ret = get_insns ();
5135 end_sequence ();
5136 return ret;
5140 /* Split an integer abs operation returning a SEQUENCE containing all of the
5141 insns. */
5144 frv_split_abs (rtx operands[])
5146 rtx dest = operands[0];
5147 rtx src = operands[1];
5148 rtx cc_reg = operands[2];
5149 rtx cr_reg = operands[3];
5150 rtx ret;
5152 start_sequence ();
5154 /* Issue the compare < 0 instruction. */
5155 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5156 cc_reg,
5157 gen_rtx_COMPARE (CCmode, src, const0_rtx)));
5159 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
5160 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5161 cr_reg,
5162 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (LT, CC_CCRmode, cc_reg, const0_rtx)));
5164 /* Emit the conditional negate if the value is negative. */
5165 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5166 gen_rtx_NE (CC_CCRmode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5167 gen_negsi2 (dest, src)));
5169 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being false if needed. */
5170 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src))
5171 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5172 gen_rtx_EQ (CC_CCRmode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5173 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src)));
5175 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
5176 ret = get_insns ();
5177 end_sequence ();
5178 return ret;
5182 /* An internal function called by for_each_rtx to clear in a hard_reg set each
5183 register used in an insn. */
5185 static int
5186 frv_clear_registers_used (rtx *ptr, void *data)
5188 if (GET_CODE (*ptr) == REG)
5190 int regno = REGNO (*ptr);
5191 HARD_REG_SET *p_regs = (HARD_REG_SET *)data;
5193 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5195 int reg_max = regno + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (*ptr));
5197 while (regno < reg_max)
5199 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (*p_regs, regno);
5200 regno++;
5205 return 0;
5209 /* Initialize machine-specific if-conversion data.
5210 On the FR-V, we don't have any extra fields per se, but it is useful hook to
5211 initialize the static storage. */
5212 void
5213 frv_ifcvt_machdep_init (void *ce_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5215 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
5216 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
5217 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec = 0;
5218 frv_ifcvt.cr_reg = NULL_RTX;
5219 frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg = NULL_RTX;
5220 frv_ifcvt.extra_int_cr = NULL_RTX;
5221 frv_ifcvt.extra_fp_cr = NULL_RTX;
5222 frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr = NULL_RTX;
5226 /* Internal function to add a potential insn to the list of insns to be inserted
5227 if the conditional execution conversion is successful. */
5229 static void
5230 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (rtx pattern, rtx insn, int before_p)
5232 rtx link = alloc_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, pattern, insn);
5234 link->jump = before_p; /* Mark to add this before or after insn. */
5235 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = alloc_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, link,
5236 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list);
5238 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5240 fprintf (stderr,
5241 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_add_insn: add the following %s insn %d:\n",
5242 (before_p) ? "before" : "after",
5243 (int)INSN_UID (insn));
5245 debug_rtx (pattern);
5250 /* A C expression to modify the code described by the conditional if
5251 information CE_INFO, possibly updating the tests in TRUE_EXPR, and
5252 FALSE_EXPR for converting if-then and if-then-else code to conditional
5253 instructions. Set either TRUE_EXPR or FALSE_EXPR to a null pointer if the
5254 tests cannot be converted. */
5256 void
5257 frv_ifcvt_modify_tests (ce_if_block *ce_info, rtx *p_true, rtx *p_false)
5259 basic_block test_bb = ce_info->test_bb; /* test basic block */
5260 basic_block then_bb = ce_info->then_bb; /* THEN */
5261 basic_block else_bb = ce_info->else_bb; /* ELSE or NULL */
5262 basic_block join_bb = ce_info->join_bb; /* join block or NULL */
5263 rtx true_expr = *p_true;
5264 rtx cr;
5265 rtx cc;
5266 rtx nested_cc;
5267 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (true_expr);
5268 int j;
5269 basic_block *bb;
5270 int num_bb;
5271 frv_tmp_reg_t *tmp_reg = &frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg;
5272 rtx check_insn;
5273 rtx sub_cond_exec_reg;
5274 enum rtx_code code;
5275 enum rtx_code code_true;
5276 enum rtx_code code_false;
5277 enum reg_class cc_class;
5278 enum reg_class cr_class;
5279 int cc_first;
5280 int cc_last;
5281 reg_set_iterator rsi;
5283 /* Make sure we are only dealing with hard registers. Also honor the
5284 -mno-cond-exec switch, and -mno-nested-cond-exec switches if
5285 applicable. */
5286 if (!reload_completed || !TARGET_COND_EXEC
5287 || (!TARGET_NESTED_CE && ce_info->pass > 1))
5288 goto fail;
5290 /* Figure out which registers we can allocate for our own purposes. Only
5291 consider registers that are not preserved across function calls and are
5292 not fixed. However, allow the ICC/ICR temporary registers to be allocated
5293 if we did not need to use them in reloading other registers. */
5294 memset (&tmp_reg->regs, 0, sizeof (tmp_reg->regs));
5295 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (tmp_reg->regs, call_used_reg_set);
5296 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (tmp_reg->regs, fixed_reg_set);
5297 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, ICC_TEMP);
5298 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, ICR_TEMP);
5300 /* If this is a nested IF, we need to discover whether the CC registers that
5301 are set/used inside of the block are used anywhere else. If not, we can
5302 change them to be the CC register that is paired with the CR register that
5303 controls the outermost IF block. */
5304 if (ce_info->pass > 1)
5306 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite);
5307 for (j = CC_FIRST; j <= CC_LAST; j++)
5308 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
5310 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (then_bb), j))
5311 continue;
5313 if (else_bb
5314 && REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (else_bb), j))
5315 continue;
5317 if (join_bb
5318 && REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (join_bb), j))
5319 continue;
5321 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite, j);
5325 for (j = 0; j < frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs; j++)
5326 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[j] = NULL_RTX;
5328 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
5329 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
5331 bb = (basic_block *) alloca ((2 + ce_info->num_multiple_test_blocks)
5332 * sizeof (basic_block));
5334 if (join_bb)
5336 unsigned int regno;
5338 /* Remove anything live at the beginning of the join block from being
5339 available for allocation. */
5340 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (df_get_live_in (join_bb), 0, regno, rsi)
5342 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5343 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, regno);
5347 /* Add in all of the blocks in multiple &&/|| blocks to be scanned. */
5348 num_bb = 0;
5349 if (ce_info->num_multiple_test_blocks)
5351 basic_block multiple_test_bb = ce_info->last_test_bb;
5353 while (multiple_test_bb != test_bb)
5355 bb[num_bb++] = multiple_test_bb;
5356 multiple_test_bb = EDGE_PRED (multiple_test_bb, 0)->src;
5360 /* Add in the THEN and ELSE blocks to be scanned. */
5361 bb[num_bb++] = then_bb;
5362 if (else_bb)
5363 bb[num_bb++] = else_bb;
5365 sub_cond_exec_reg = NULL_RTX;
5366 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec = 0;
5368 /* Scan all of the blocks for registers that must not be allocated. */
5369 for (j = 0; j < num_bb; j++)
5371 rtx_insn *last_insn = BB_END (bb[j]);
5372 rtx_insn *insn = BB_HEAD (bb[j]);
5373 unsigned int regno;
5375 if (dump_file)
5376 fprintf (dump_file, "Scanning %s block %d, start %d, end %d\n",
5377 (bb[j] == else_bb) ? "else" : ((bb[j] == then_bb) ? "then" : "test"),
5378 (int) bb[j]->index,
5379 (int) INSN_UID (BB_HEAD (bb[j])),
5380 (int) INSN_UID (BB_END (bb[j])));
5382 /* Anything live at the beginning of the block is obviously unavailable
5383 for allocation. */
5384 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (df_get_live_in (bb[j]), 0, regno, rsi)
5386 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5387 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, regno);
5390 /* Loop through the insns in the block. */
5391 for (;;)
5393 /* Mark any new registers that are created as being unavailable for
5394 allocation. Also see if the CC register used in nested IFs can be
5395 reallocated. */
5396 if (INSN_P (insn))
5398 rtx pattern;
5399 rtx set;
5400 int skip_nested_if = FALSE;
5402 for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), frv_clear_registers_used,
5403 (void *)&tmp_reg->regs);
5405 pattern = PATTERN (insn);
5406 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == COND_EXEC)
5408 rtx reg = XEXP (COND_EXEC_TEST (pattern), 0);
5410 if (reg != sub_cond_exec_reg)
5412 sub_cond_exec_reg = reg;
5413 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec++;
5417 set = single_set_pattern (pattern);
5418 if (set)
5420 rtx dest = SET_DEST (set);
5421 rtx src = SET_SRC (set);
5423 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
5425 int regno = REGNO (dest);
5426 enum rtx_code src_code = GET_CODE (src);
5428 if (CC_P (regno) && src_code == COMPARE)
5429 skip_nested_if = TRUE;
5431 else if (CR_P (regno)
5432 && (src_code == IF_THEN_ELSE
5433 || COMPARISON_P (src)))
5434 skip_nested_if = TRUE;
5438 if (! skip_nested_if)
5439 for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), frv_clear_registers_used,
5440 (void *)&frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite);
5443 if (insn == last_insn)
5444 break;
5446 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
5450 /* If this is a nested if, rewrite the CC registers that are available to
5451 include the ones that can be rewritten, to increase the chance of being
5452 able to allocate a paired CC/CR register combination. */
5453 if (ce_info->pass > 1)
5455 for (j = CC_FIRST; j <= CC_LAST; j++)
5456 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite, j))
5457 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j);
5458 else
5459 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j);
5462 if (dump_file)
5464 int num_gprs = 0;
5465 fprintf (dump_file, "Available GPRs: ");
5467 for (j = GPR_FIRST; j <= GPR_LAST; j++)
5468 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
5470 fprintf (dump_file, " %d [%s]", j, reg_names[j]);
5471 if (++num_gprs > GPR_TEMP_NUM+2)
5472 break;
5475 fprintf (dump_file, "%s\nAvailable CRs: ",
5476 (num_gprs > GPR_TEMP_NUM+2) ? " ..." : "");
5478 for (j = CR_FIRST; j <= CR_LAST; j++)
5479 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
5480 fprintf (dump_file, " %d [%s]", j, reg_names[j]);
5482 fputs ("\n", dump_file);
5484 if (ce_info->pass > 1)
5486 fprintf (dump_file, "Modifiable CCs: ");
5487 for (j = CC_FIRST; j <= CC_LAST; j++)
5488 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
5489 fprintf (dump_file, " %d [%s]", j, reg_names[j]);
5491 fprintf (dump_file, "\n%d nested COND_EXEC statements\n",
5492 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec);
5496 /* Allocate the appropriate temporary condition code register. Try to
5497 allocate the ICR/FCR register that corresponds to the ICC/FCC register so
5498 that conditional cmp's can be done. */
5499 if (mode == CCmode || mode == CC_UNSmode || mode == CC_NZmode)
5501 cr_class = ICR_REGS;
5502 cc_class = ICC_REGS;
5503 cc_first = ICC_FIRST;
5504 cc_last = ICC_LAST;
5506 else if (mode == CC_FPmode)
5508 cr_class = FCR_REGS;
5509 cc_class = FCC_REGS;
5510 cc_first = FCC_FIRST;
5511 cc_last = FCC_LAST;
5513 else
5515 cc_first = cc_last = 0;
5516 cr_class = cc_class = NO_REGS;
5519 cc = XEXP (true_expr, 0);
5520 nested_cc = cr = NULL_RTX;
5521 if (cc_class != NO_REGS)
5523 /* For nested IFs and &&/||, see if we can find a CC and CR register pair
5524 so we can execute a csubcc/caddcc/cfcmps instruction. */
5525 int cc_regno;
5527 for (cc_regno = cc_first; cc_regno <= cc_last; cc_regno++)
5529 int cr_regno = cc_regno - CC_FIRST + CR_FIRST;
5531 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.regs, cc_regno)
5532 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.regs, cr_regno))
5534 frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.next_reg[ (int)cr_class ] = cr_regno;
5535 cr = frv_alloc_temp_reg (tmp_reg, cr_class, CC_CCRmode, TRUE,
5536 TRUE);
5538 frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.next_reg[ (int)cc_class ] = cc_regno;
5539 nested_cc = frv_alloc_temp_reg (tmp_reg, cc_class, CCmode,
5540 TRUE, TRUE);
5541 break;
5546 if (! cr)
5548 if (dump_file)
5549 fprintf (dump_file, "Could not allocate a CR temporary register\n");
5551 goto fail;
5554 if (dump_file)
5555 fprintf (dump_file,
5556 "Will use %s for conditional execution, %s for nested comparisons\n",
5557 reg_names[ REGNO (cr)],
5558 (nested_cc) ? reg_names[ REGNO (nested_cc) ] : "<none>");
5560 /* Set the CCR bit. Note for integer tests, we reverse the condition so that
5561 in an IF-THEN-ELSE sequence, we are testing the TRUE case against the CCR
5562 bit being true. We don't do this for floating point, because of NaNs. */
5563 code = GET_CODE (true_expr);
5564 if (GET_MODE (cc) != CC_FPmode)
5566 code = reverse_condition (code);
5567 code_true = EQ;
5568 code_false = NE;
5570 else
5572 code_true = NE;
5573 code_false = EQ;
5576 check_insn = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, cr,
5577 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, CC_CCRmode, cc, const0_rtx));
5579 /* Record the check insn to be inserted later. */
5580 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (check_insn, BB_END (test_bb), TRUE);
5582 /* Update the tests. */
5583 frv_ifcvt.cr_reg = cr;
5584 frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg = nested_cc;
5585 *p_true = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code_true, CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5586 *p_false = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code_false, CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5587 return;
5589 /* Fail, don't do this conditional execution. */
5590 fail:
5591 *p_true = NULL_RTX;
5592 *p_false = NULL_RTX;
5593 if (dump_file)
5594 fprintf (dump_file, "Disabling this conditional execution.\n");
5596 return;
5600 /* A C expression to modify the code described by the conditional if
5601 information CE_INFO, for the basic block BB, possibly updating the tests in
5602 TRUE_EXPR, and FALSE_EXPR for converting the && and || parts of if-then or
5603 if-then-else code to conditional instructions. Set either TRUE_EXPR or
5604 FALSE_EXPR to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted. */
5606 /* p_true and p_false are given expressions of the form:
5608 (and (eq:CC_CCR (reg:CC_CCR)
5609 (const_int 0))
5610 (eq:CC (reg:CC)
5611 (const_int 0))) */
5613 void
5614 frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests (ce_if_block *ce_info,
5615 basic_block bb,
5616 rtx *p_true,
5617 rtx *p_false)
5619 rtx old_true = XEXP (*p_true, 0);
5620 rtx old_false = XEXP (*p_false, 0);
5621 rtx true_expr = XEXP (*p_true, 1);
5622 rtx false_expr = XEXP (*p_false, 1);
5623 rtx test_expr;
5624 rtx old_test;
5625 rtx cr = XEXP (old_true, 0);
5626 rtx check_insn;
5627 rtx new_cr = NULL_RTX;
5628 rtx *p_new_cr = (rtx *)0;
5629 rtx if_else;
5630 rtx compare;
5631 rtx cc;
5632 enum reg_class cr_class;
5633 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (true_expr);
5634 rtx (*logical_func)(rtx, rtx, rtx);
5636 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5638 fprintf (stderr,
5639 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests, before modification for %s\ntrue insn:\n",
5640 ce_info->and_and_p ? "&&" : "||");
5642 debug_rtx (*p_true);
5644 fputs ("\nfalse insn:\n", stderr);
5645 debug_rtx (*p_false);
5648 if (!TARGET_MULTI_CE)
5649 goto fail;
5651 if (GET_CODE (cr) != REG)
5652 goto fail;
5654 if (mode == CCmode || mode == CC_UNSmode || mode == CC_NZmode)
5656 cr_class = ICR_REGS;
5657 p_new_cr = &frv_ifcvt.extra_int_cr;
5659 else if (mode == CC_FPmode)
5661 cr_class = FCR_REGS;
5662 p_new_cr = &frv_ifcvt.extra_fp_cr;
5664 else
5665 goto fail;
5667 /* Allocate a temp CR, reusing a previously allocated temp CR if we have 3 or
5668 more &&/|| tests. */
5669 new_cr = *p_new_cr;
5670 if (! new_cr)
5672 new_cr = *p_new_cr = frv_alloc_temp_reg (&frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg, cr_class,
5673 CC_CCRmode, TRUE, TRUE);
5674 if (! new_cr)
5675 goto fail;
5678 if (ce_info->and_and_p)
5680 old_test = old_false;
5681 test_expr = true_expr;
5682 logical_func = (GET_CODE (old_true) == EQ) ? gen_andcr : gen_andncr;
5683 *p_true = gen_rtx_NE (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5684 *p_false = gen_rtx_EQ (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5686 else
5688 old_test = old_false;
5689 test_expr = false_expr;
5690 logical_func = (GET_CODE (old_false) == EQ) ? gen_orcr : gen_orncr;
5691 *p_true = gen_rtx_EQ (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5692 *p_false = gen_rtx_NE (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5695 /* First add the andcr/andncr/orcr/orncr, which will be added after the
5696 conditional check instruction, due to frv_ifcvt_add_insn being a LIFO
5697 stack. */
5698 frv_ifcvt_add_insn ((*logical_func) (cr, cr, new_cr), BB_END (bb), TRUE);
5700 /* Now add the conditional check insn. */
5701 cc = XEXP (test_expr, 0);
5702 compare = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (test_expr), CC_CCRmode, cc, const0_rtx);
5703 if_else = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (CC_CCRmode, old_test, compare, const0_rtx);
5705 check_insn = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, new_cr, if_else);
5707 /* Add the new check insn to the list of check insns that need to be
5708 inserted. */
5709 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (check_insn, BB_END (bb), TRUE);
5711 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5713 fputs ("\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests, after modification\ntrue insn:\n",
5714 stderr);
5716 debug_rtx (*p_true);
5718 fputs ("\nfalse insn:\n", stderr);
5719 debug_rtx (*p_false);
5722 return;
5724 fail:
5725 *p_true = *p_false = NULL_RTX;
5727 /* If we allocated a CR register, release it. */
5728 if (new_cr)
5730 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.regs, REGNO (new_cr));
5731 *p_new_cr = NULL_RTX;
5734 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5735 fputs ("\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests, failed.\n", stderr);
5737 return;
5741 /* Return a register which will be loaded with a value if an IF block is
5742 converted to conditional execution. This is used to rewrite instructions
5743 that use constants to ones that just use registers. */
5745 static rtx
5746 frv_ifcvt_load_value (rtx value, rtx insn ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5748 int num_alloc = frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs;
5749 int i;
5750 rtx reg;
5752 /* We know gr0 == 0, so replace any errant uses. */
5753 if (value == const0_rtx)
5754 return gen_rtx_REG (SImode, GPR_FIRST);
5756 /* First search all registers currently loaded to see if we have an
5757 applicable constant. */
5758 if (CONSTANT_P (value)
5759 || (GET_CODE (value) == REG && REGNO (value) == LR_REGNO))
5761 for (i = 0; i < num_alloc; i++)
5763 if (rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i]), value))
5764 return SET_DEST (frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i]);
5768 /* Have we exhausted the number of registers available? */
5769 if (num_alloc >= GPR_TEMP_NUM)
5771 if (dump_file)
5772 fprintf (dump_file, "Too many temporary registers allocated\n");
5774 return NULL_RTX;
5777 /* Allocate the new register. */
5778 reg = frv_alloc_temp_reg (&frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg, GPR_REGS, SImode, TRUE, TRUE);
5779 if (! reg)
5781 if (dump_file)
5782 fputs ("Could not find a scratch register\n", dump_file);
5784 return NULL_RTX;
5787 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs++;
5788 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[num_alloc] = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, value);
5790 if (dump_file)
5792 if (GET_CODE (value) == CONST_INT)
5793 fprintf (dump_file, "Register %s will hold %ld\n",
5794 reg_names[ REGNO (reg)], (long)INTVAL (value));
5796 else if (GET_CODE (value) == REG && REGNO (value) == LR_REGNO)
5797 fprintf (dump_file, "Register %s will hold LR\n",
5798 reg_names[ REGNO (reg)]);
5800 else
5801 fprintf (dump_file, "Register %s will hold a saved value\n",
5802 reg_names[ REGNO (reg)]);
5805 return reg;
5809 /* Update a MEM used in conditional code that might contain an offset to put
5810 the offset into a scratch register, so that the conditional load/store
5811 operations can be used. This function returns the original pointer if the
5812 MEM is valid to use in conditional code, NULL if we can't load up the offset
5813 into a temporary register, or the new MEM if we were successful. */
5815 static rtx
5816 frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (rtx mem, enum machine_mode mode, rtx insn)
5818 rtx addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
5820 if (!frv_legitimate_address_p_1 (mode, addr, reload_completed, TRUE, FALSE))
5822 if (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS)
5824 rtx addr_op0 = XEXP (addr, 0);
5825 rtx addr_op1 = XEXP (addr, 1);
5827 if (GET_CODE (addr_op0) == REG && CONSTANT_P (addr_op1))
5829 rtx reg = frv_ifcvt_load_value (addr_op1, insn);
5830 if (!reg)
5831 return NULL_RTX;
5833 addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, addr_op0, reg);
5836 else
5837 return NULL_RTX;
5840 else if (CONSTANT_P (addr))
5841 addr = frv_ifcvt_load_value (addr, insn);
5843 else
5844 return NULL_RTX;
5846 if (addr == NULL_RTX)
5847 return NULL_RTX;
5849 else if (XEXP (mem, 0) != addr)
5850 return change_address (mem, mode, addr);
5853 return mem;
5857 /* Given a PATTERN, return a SET expression if this PATTERN has only a single
5858 SET, possibly conditionally executed. It may also have CLOBBERs, USEs. */
5860 static rtx
5861 single_set_pattern (rtx pattern)
5863 rtx set;
5864 int i;
5866 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == COND_EXEC)
5867 pattern = COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern);
5869 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == SET)
5870 return pattern;
5872 else if (GET_CODE (pattern) == PARALLEL)
5874 for (i = 0, set = 0; i < XVECLEN (pattern, 0); i++)
5876 rtx sub = XVECEXP (pattern, 0, i);
5878 switch (GET_CODE (sub))
5880 case USE:
5881 case CLOBBER:
5882 break;
5884 case SET:
5885 if (set)
5886 return 0;
5887 else
5888 set = sub;
5889 break;
5891 default:
5892 return 0;
5895 return set;
5898 return 0;
5902 /* A C expression to modify the code described by the conditional if
5903 information CE_INFO with the new PATTERN in INSN. If PATTERN is a null
5904 pointer after the IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN macro executes, it is assumed that that
5905 insn cannot be converted to be executed conditionally. */
5908 frv_ifcvt_modify_insn (ce_if_block *ce_info,
5909 rtx pattern,
5910 rtx insn)
5912 rtx orig_ce_pattern = pattern;
5913 rtx set;
5914 rtx op0;
5915 rtx op1;
5916 rtx test;
5918 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (pattern) == COND_EXEC);
5920 test = COND_EXEC_TEST (pattern);
5921 if (GET_CODE (test) == AND)
5923 rtx cr = frv_ifcvt.cr_reg;
5924 rtx test_reg;
5926 op0 = XEXP (test, 0);
5927 if (! rtx_equal_p (cr, XEXP (op0, 0)))
5928 goto fail;
5930 op1 = XEXP (test, 1);
5931 test_reg = XEXP (op1, 0);
5932 if (GET_CODE (test_reg) != REG)
5933 goto fail;
5935 /* Is this the first nested if block in this sequence? If so, generate
5936 an andcr or andncr. */
5937 if (! frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr)
5939 rtx and_op;
5941 frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr = test_reg;
5942 if (GET_CODE (op0) == NE)
5943 and_op = gen_andcr (test_reg, cr, test_reg);
5944 else
5945 and_op = gen_andncr (test_reg, cr, test_reg);
5947 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (and_op, insn, TRUE);
5950 /* If this isn't the first statement in the nested if sequence, see if we
5951 are dealing with the same register. */
5952 else if (! rtx_equal_p (test_reg, frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr))
5953 goto fail;
5955 COND_EXEC_TEST (pattern) = test = op1;
5958 /* If this isn't a nested if, reset state variables. */
5959 else
5961 frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr = NULL_RTX;
5964 set = single_set_pattern (pattern);
5965 if (set)
5967 rtx dest = SET_DEST (set);
5968 rtx src = SET_SRC (set);
5969 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
5971 /* Check for normal binary operators. */
5972 if (mode == SImode && ARITHMETIC_P (src))
5974 op0 = XEXP (src, 0);
5975 op1 = XEXP (src, 1);
5977 if (integer_register_operand (op0, SImode) && CONSTANT_P (op1))
5979 op1 = frv_ifcvt_load_value (op1, insn);
5980 if (op1)
5981 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern)
5982 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (src),
5983 GET_MODE (src),
5984 op0, op1));
5985 else
5986 goto fail;
5990 /* For multiply by a constant, we need to handle the sign extending
5991 correctly. Add a USE of the value after the multiply to prevent flow
5992 from cratering because only one register out of the two were used. */
5993 else if (mode == DImode && GET_CODE (src) == MULT)
5995 op0 = XEXP (src, 0);
5996 op1 = XEXP (src, 1);
5997 if (GET_CODE (op0) == SIGN_EXTEND && GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
5999 op1 = frv_ifcvt_load_value (op1, insn);
6000 if (op1)
6002 op1 = gen_rtx_SIGN_EXTEND (DImode, op1);
6003 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern)
6004 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest,
6005 gen_rtx_MULT (DImode, op0, op1));
6007 else
6008 goto fail;
6011 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (gen_use (dest), insn, FALSE);
6014 /* If we are just loading a constant created for a nested conditional
6015 execution statement, just load the constant without any conditional
6016 execution, since we know that the constant will not interfere with any
6017 other registers. */
6018 else if (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap
6019 && bitmap_bit_p (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap,
6020 INSN_UID (insn))
6021 && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
6022 /* We must not unconditionally set a scratch reg chosen
6023 for a nested if-converted block if its incoming
6024 value from the TEST block (or the result of the THEN
6025 branch) could/should propagate to the JOIN block.
6026 It suffices to test whether the register is live at
6027 the JOIN point: if it's live there, we can infer
6028 that we set it in the former JOIN block of the
6029 nested if-converted block (otherwise it wouldn't
6030 have been available as a scratch register), and it
6031 is either propagated through or set in the other
6032 conditional block. It's probably not worth trying
6033 to catch the latter case, and it could actually
6034 limit scheduling of the combined block quite
6035 severely. */
6036 && ce_info->join_bb
6037 && ! (REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (ce_info->join_bb),
6038 REGNO (SET_DEST (set))))
6039 /* Similarly, we must not unconditionally set a reg
6040 used as scratch in the THEN branch if the same reg
6041 is live in the ELSE branch. */
6042 && (! ce_info->else_bb
6043 || BLOCK_FOR_INSN (insn) == ce_info->else_bb
6044 || ! (REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (ce_info->else_bb),
6045 REGNO (SET_DEST (set))))))
6046 pattern = set;
6048 else if (mode == QImode || mode == HImode || mode == SImode
6049 || mode == SFmode)
6051 int changed_p = FALSE;
6053 /* Check for just loading up a constant */
6054 if (CONSTANT_P (src) && integer_register_operand (dest, mode))
6056 src = frv_ifcvt_load_value (src, insn);
6057 if (!src)
6058 goto fail;
6060 changed_p = TRUE;
6063 /* See if we need to fix up stores */
6064 if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
6066 rtx new_mem = frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (dest, mode, insn);
6068 if (!new_mem)
6069 goto fail;
6071 else if (new_mem != dest)
6073 changed_p = TRUE;
6074 dest = new_mem;
6078 /* See if we need to fix up loads */
6079 if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
6081 rtx new_mem = frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (src, mode, insn);
6083 if (!new_mem)
6084 goto fail;
6086 else if (new_mem != src)
6088 changed_p = TRUE;
6089 src = new_mem;
6093 /* If either src or destination changed, redo SET. */
6094 if (changed_p)
6095 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern) = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src);
6098 /* Rewrite a nested set cccr in terms of IF_THEN_ELSE. Also deal with
6099 rewriting the CC register to be the same as the paired CC/CR register
6100 for nested ifs. */
6101 else if (mode == CC_CCRmode && COMPARISON_P (src))
6103 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (src, 0));
6104 rtx if_else;
6106 if (ce_info->pass > 1
6107 && regno != (int)REGNO (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg)
6108 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite, regno))
6110 src = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (src),
6111 CC_CCRmode,
6112 frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg,
6113 XEXP (src, 1));
6116 if_else = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (CC_CCRmode, test, src, const0_rtx);
6117 pattern = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, if_else);
6120 /* Remap a nested compare instruction to use the paired CC/CR reg. */
6121 else if (ce_info->pass > 1
6122 && GET_CODE (dest) == REG
6123 && CC_P (REGNO (dest))
6124 && REGNO (dest) != REGNO (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg)
6125 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite,
6126 REGNO (dest))
6127 && GET_CODE (src) == COMPARE)
6129 PUT_MODE (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg, GET_MODE (dest));
6130 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern)
6131 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg, copy_rtx (src));
6135 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
6137 rtx orig_pattern = PATTERN (insn);
6139 PATTERN (insn) = pattern;
6140 fprintf (stderr,
6141 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_insn: pass = %d, insn after modification:\n",
6142 ce_info->pass);
6144 debug_rtx (insn);
6145 PATTERN (insn) = orig_pattern;
6148 return pattern;
6150 fail:
6151 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
6153 rtx orig_pattern = PATTERN (insn);
6155 PATTERN (insn) = orig_ce_pattern;
6156 fprintf (stderr,
6157 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_insn: pass = %d, insn could not be modified:\n",
6158 ce_info->pass);
6160 debug_rtx (insn);
6161 PATTERN (insn) = orig_pattern;
6164 return NULL_RTX;
6168 /* A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
6169 converting code to conditional execution in the code described by the
6170 conditional if information CE_INFO. */
6172 void
6173 frv_ifcvt_modify_final (ce_if_block *ce_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6175 rtx existing_insn;
6176 rtx check_insn;
6177 rtx p = frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list;
6178 int i;
6180 /* Loop inserting the check insns. The last check insn is the first test,
6181 and is the appropriate place to insert constants. */
6182 gcc_assert (p);
6186 rtx check_and_insert_insns = XEXP (p, 0);
6187 rtx old_p = p;
6189 check_insn = XEXP (check_and_insert_insns, 0);
6190 existing_insn = XEXP (check_and_insert_insns, 1);
6191 p = XEXP (p, 1);
6193 /* The jump bit is used to say that the new insn is to be inserted BEFORE
6194 the existing insn, otherwise it is to be inserted AFTER. */
6195 if (check_and_insert_insns->jump)
6197 emit_insn_before (check_insn, existing_insn);
6198 check_and_insert_insns->jump = 0;
6200 else
6201 emit_insn_after (check_insn, existing_insn);
6203 free_EXPR_LIST_node (check_and_insert_insns);
6204 free_EXPR_LIST_node (old_p);
6206 while (p != NULL_RTX);
6208 /* Load up any constants needed into temp gprs */
6209 for (i = 0; i < frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs; i++)
6211 rtx insn = emit_insn_before (frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i], existing_insn);
6212 if (! frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap)
6213 frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap = BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL);
6214 bitmap_set_bit (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap, INSN_UID (insn));
6215 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i] = NULL_RTX;
6218 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
6219 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
6223 /* A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in converting
6224 code to conditional execution in the code described by the conditional if
6225 information CE_INFO. */
6227 void
6228 frv_ifcvt_modify_cancel (ce_if_block *ce_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6230 int i;
6231 rtx p = frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list;
6233 /* Loop freeing up the EXPR_LIST's allocated. */
6234 while (p != NULL_RTX)
6236 rtx check_and_jump = XEXP (p, 0);
6237 rtx old_p = p;
6239 p = XEXP (p, 1);
6240 free_EXPR_LIST_node (check_and_jump);
6241 free_EXPR_LIST_node (old_p);
6244 /* Release any temporary gprs allocated. */
6245 for (i = 0; i < frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs; i++)
6246 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i] = NULL_RTX;
6248 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
6249 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
6250 return;
6253 /* A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
6254 The template is:
6256 setlo #0, <jmp_reg>
6257 setlo #0, <static_chain>
6258 sethi #0, <jmp_reg>
6259 sethi #0, <static_chain>
6260 jmpl @(gr0,<jmp_reg>) */
6263 frv_trampoline_size (void)
6265 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
6266 /* Allocate room for the function descriptor and the lddi
6267 instruction. */
6268 return 8 + 6 * 4;
6269 return 5 /* instructions */ * 4 /* instruction size. */;
6273 /* A C statement to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline. ADDR is an
6274 RTX for the address of the trampoline; FNADDR is an RTX for the address of
6275 the nested function; STATIC_CHAIN is an RTX for the static chain value that
6276 should be passed to the function when it is called.
6278 The template is:
6280 setlo #0, <jmp_reg>
6281 setlo #0, <static_chain>
6282 sethi #0, <jmp_reg>
6283 sethi #0, <static_chain>
6284 jmpl @(gr0,<jmp_reg>) */
6286 static void
6287 frv_trampoline_init (rtx m_tramp, tree fndecl, rtx static_chain)
6289 rtx addr = XEXP (m_tramp, 0);
6290 rtx fnaddr = XEXP (DECL_RTL (fndecl), 0);
6291 rtx sc_reg = force_reg (Pmode, static_chain);
6293 emit_library_call (gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (SImode, "__trampoline_setup"),
6294 LCT_NORMAL, VOIDmode, 4,
6295 addr, Pmode,
6296 GEN_INT (frv_trampoline_size ()), SImode,
6297 fnaddr, Pmode,
6298 sc_reg, Pmode);
6302 /* Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or from
6303 memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the `MQ'
6304 register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or from general
6305 registers, but not memory. Some machines allow copying all registers to and
6306 from memory, but require a scratch register for stores to some memory
6307 locations (e.g., those with symbolic address on the RT, and those with
6308 certain symbolic address on the SPARC when compiling PIC). In some cases,
6309 both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
6311 You should define these macros to indicate to the reload phase that it may
6312 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
6313 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying X to a register
6314 RCLASS in MODE requires an intermediate register, you should define
6315 `SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS' to return the largest register class all of
6316 whose registers can be used as intermediate registers or scratch registers.
6318 If copying a register RCLASS in MODE to X requires an intermediate or scratch
6319 register, `SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS' should be defined to return the
6320 largest register class required. If the requirements for input and output
6321 reloads are the same, the macro `SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS' should be used
6322 instead of defining both macros identically.
6324 The values returned by these macros are often `GENERAL_REGS'. Return
6325 `NO_REGS' if no spare register is needed; i.e., if X can be directly copied
6326 to or from a register of RCLASS in MODE without requiring a scratch register.
6327 Do not define this macro if it would always return `NO_REGS'.
6329 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an intermediate
6330 register), you should define patterns for `reload_inM' or `reload_outM', as
6331 required.. These patterns, which will normally be implemented with a
6332 `define_expand', should be similar to the `movM' patterns, except that
6333 operand 2 is the scratch register.
6335 Define constraints for the reload register and scratch register that contain
6336 a single register class. If the original reload register (whose class is
6337 RCLASS) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the value returned by
6338 these macros is used for the class of the scratch register. Otherwise, two
6339 additional reload registers are required. Their classes are obtained from
6340 the constraints in the insn pattern.
6342 X might be a pseudo-register or a `subreg' of a pseudo-register, which could
6343 either be in a hard register or in memory. Use `true_regnum' to find out;
6344 it will return -1 if the pseudo is in memory and the hard register number if
6345 it is in a register.
6347 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
6348 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
6349 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
6350 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform the
6351 copy and the `movM' pattern should use memory as an intermediate storage.
6352 This case often occurs between floating-point and general registers. */
6354 enum reg_class
6355 frv_secondary_reload_class (enum reg_class rclass,
6356 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6357 rtx x)
6359 enum reg_class ret;
6361 switch (rclass)
6363 default:
6364 ret = NO_REGS;
6365 break;
6367 /* Accumulators/Accumulator guard registers need to go through floating
6368 point registers. */
6369 case QUAD_REGS:
6370 case GPR_REGS:
6371 ret = NO_REGS;
6372 if (x && GET_CODE (x) == REG)
6374 int regno = REGNO (x);
6376 if (ACC_P (regno) || ACCG_P (regno))
6377 ret = FPR_REGS;
6379 break;
6381 /* Nonzero constants should be loaded into an FPR through a GPR. */
6382 case QUAD_FPR_REGS:
6383 if (x && CONSTANT_P (x) && !ZERO_P (x))
6384 ret = GPR_REGS;
6385 else
6386 ret = NO_REGS;
6387 break;
6389 /* All of these types need gpr registers. */
6390 case ICC_REGS:
6391 case FCC_REGS:
6392 case CC_REGS:
6393 case ICR_REGS:
6394 case FCR_REGS:
6395 case CR_REGS:
6396 case LCR_REG:
6397 case LR_REG:
6398 ret = GPR_REGS;
6399 break;
6401 /* The accumulators need fpr registers. */
6402 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
6403 case ACCG_REGS:
6404 ret = FPR_REGS;
6405 break;
6408 return ret;
6411 /* This hook exists to catch the case where secondary_reload_class() is
6412 called from init_reg_autoinc() in regclass.c - before the reload optabs
6413 have been initialised. */
6415 static reg_class_t
6416 frv_secondary_reload (bool in_p, rtx x, reg_class_t reload_class_i,
6417 enum machine_mode reload_mode,
6418 secondary_reload_info * sri)
6420 enum reg_class rclass = NO_REGS;
6421 enum reg_class reload_class = (enum reg_class) reload_class_i;
6423 if (sri->prev_sri && sri->prev_sri->t_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6425 sri->icode = sri->prev_sri->t_icode;
6426 return NO_REGS;
6429 rclass = frv_secondary_reload_class (reload_class, reload_mode, x);
6431 if (rclass != NO_REGS)
6433 enum insn_code icode
6434 = direct_optab_handler (in_p ? reload_in_optab : reload_out_optab,
6435 reload_mode);
6436 if (icode == 0)
6438 /* This happens when then the reload_[in|out]_optabs have
6439 not been initialised. */
6440 sri->t_icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
6441 return rclass;
6445 /* Fall back to the default secondary reload handler. */
6446 return default_secondary_reload (in_p, x, reload_class, reload_mode, sri);
6450 /* Worker function for TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P. */
6452 static bool
6453 frv_class_likely_spilled_p (reg_class_t rclass)
6455 switch (rclass)
6457 default:
6458 break;
6460 case GR8_REGS:
6461 case GR9_REGS:
6462 case GR89_REGS:
6463 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6464 case FDPIC_REGS:
6465 case ICC_REGS:
6466 case FCC_REGS:
6467 case CC_REGS:
6468 case ICR_REGS:
6469 case FCR_REGS:
6470 case CR_REGS:
6471 case LCR_REG:
6472 case LR_REG:
6473 case SPR_REGS:
6474 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
6475 case ACCG_REGS:
6476 return true;
6479 return false;
6483 /* An expression for the alignment of a structure field FIELD if the
6484 alignment computed in the usual way is COMPUTED. GCC uses this
6485 value instead of the value in `BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT' or
6486 `BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT', if defined, for structure fields only. */
6488 /* The definition type of the bit field data is either char, short, long or
6489 long long. The maximum bit size is the number of bits of its own type.
6491 The bit field data is assigned to a storage unit that has an adequate size
6492 for bit field data retention and is located at the smallest address.
6494 Consecutive bit field data are packed at consecutive bits having the same
6495 storage unit, with regard to the type, beginning with the MSB and continuing
6496 toward the LSB.
6498 If a field to be assigned lies over a bit field type boundary, its
6499 assignment is completed by aligning it with a boundary suitable for the
6500 type.
6502 When a bit field having a bit length of 0 is declared, it is forcibly
6503 assigned to the next storage unit.
6505 e.g)
6506 struct {
6507 int a:2;
6508 int b:6;
6509 char c:4;
6510 int d:10;
6511 int :0;
6512 int f:2;
6513 } x;
6515 +0 +1 +2 +3
6516 &x 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6517 MLM----L
6519 &x+4 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6520 M--L
6522 &x+8 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6523 M----------L
6525 &x+12 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6531 frv_adjust_field_align (tree field, int computed)
6533 /* Make sure that the bitfield is not wider than the type. */
6534 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
6535 && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (field))
6537 tree parent = DECL_CONTEXT (field);
6538 tree prev = NULL_TREE;
6539 tree cur;
6541 for (cur = TYPE_FIELDS (parent); cur && cur != field; cur = DECL_CHAIN (cur))
6543 if (TREE_CODE (cur) != FIELD_DECL)
6544 continue;
6546 prev = cur;
6549 gcc_assert (cur);
6551 /* If this isn't a :0 field and if the previous element is a bitfield
6552 also, see if the type is different, if so, we will need to align the
6553 bit-field to the next boundary. */
6554 if (prev
6555 && ! DECL_PACKED (field)
6556 && ! integer_zerop (DECL_SIZE (field))
6557 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (field) != DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (prev))
6559 int prev_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (prev));
6560 int cur_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (field));
6561 computed = (prev_align > cur_align) ? prev_align : cur_align;
6565 return computed;
6569 /* A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value of mode
6570 MODE in hard register number REGNO (or in several registers starting with
6571 that one). For a machine where all registers are equivalent, a suitable
6572 definition is
6574 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
6576 It is not necessary for this macro to check for the numbers of fixed
6577 registers, because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always
6578 occupied.
6580 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd register
6581 pairs. The way to implement that is to define this macro to reject odd
6582 register numbers for such modes.
6584 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
6585 `movMODE' instruction pattern support moves between the register and any
6586 other hard register for which the mode is OK; and that moving a value into
6587 the register and back out not alter it.
6589 Since the same instruction used to move `SImode' will work for all narrower
6590 integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK'
6591 to distinguish between these modes, provided you define patterns `movhi',
6592 etc., to take advantage of this. This is useful because of the interaction
6593 between `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK' and `MODES_TIEABLE_P'; it is very desirable for
6594 all integer modes to be tieable.
6596 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic. Often
6597 people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only in floating
6598 point registers. This is not true. Any registers that can hold integers
6599 can safely *hold* a floating point machine mode, whether or not floating
6600 arithmetic can be done on it in those registers. Integer move instructions
6601 can be used to move the values.
6603 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine modes
6604 may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating registers
6605 normalize any value stored in them, because storing a non-floating value
6606 there would garble it. In this case, `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK' should reject
6607 fixed-point machine modes in floating registers. But if the floating
6608 registers do not automatically normalize, if you can store any bit pattern
6609 in one and retrieve it unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may
6610 go in a floating register, so you can define this macro to say so.
6612 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that they
6613 are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic instructions.
6614 However, this is of no concern to `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK'. You handle it by
6615 writing the proper constraints for those instructions.
6617 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access, so
6618 that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a register
6619 if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the floating
6620 registers are not in class `GENERAL_REGS', they will not be used unless some
6621 pattern's constraint asks for one. */
6624 frv_hard_regno_mode_ok (int regno, enum machine_mode mode)
6626 int base;
6627 int mask;
6629 switch (mode)
6631 case CCmode:
6632 case CC_UNSmode:
6633 case CC_NZmode:
6634 return ICC_P (regno) || GPR_P (regno);
6636 case CC_CCRmode:
6637 return CR_P (regno) || GPR_P (regno);
6639 case CC_FPmode:
6640 return FCC_P (regno) || GPR_P (regno);
6642 default:
6643 break;
6646 /* Set BASE to the first register in REGNO's class. Set MASK to the
6647 bits that must be clear in (REGNO - BASE) for the register to be
6648 well-aligned. */
6649 if (INTEGRAL_MODE_P (mode) || FLOAT_MODE_P (mode) || VECTOR_MODE_P (mode))
6651 if (ACCG_P (regno))
6653 /* ACCGs store one byte. Two-byte quantities must start in
6654 even-numbered registers, four-byte ones in registers whose
6655 numbers are divisible by four, and so on. */
6656 base = ACCG_FIRST;
6657 mask = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1;
6659 else
6661 /* The other registers store one word. */
6662 if (GPR_P (regno) || regno == AP_FIRST)
6663 base = GPR_FIRST;
6665 else if (FPR_P (regno))
6666 base = FPR_FIRST;
6668 else if (ACC_P (regno))
6669 base = ACC_FIRST;
6671 else if (SPR_P (regno))
6672 return mode == SImode;
6674 /* Fill in the table. */
6675 else
6676 return 0;
6678 /* Anything smaller than an SI is OK in any word-sized register. */
6679 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < 4)
6680 return 1;
6682 mask = (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 4) - 1;
6684 return (((regno - base) & mask) == 0);
6687 return 0;
6691 /* A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting at
6692 register number REGNO, required to hold a value of mode MODE.
6694 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable definition
6695 of this macro is
6697 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
6698 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
6699 / UNITS_PER_WORD)) */
6701 /* On the FRV, make the CC_FP mode take 3 words in the integer registers, so
6702 that we can build the appropriate instructions to properly reload the
6703 values. Also, make the byte-sized accumulator guards use one guard
6704 for each byte. */
6707 frv_hard_regno_nregs (int regno, enum machine_mode mode)
6709 if (ACCG_P (regno))
6710 return GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
6711 else
6712 return (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
6716 /* A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers of
6717 class RCLASS needed to hold a value of mode MODE.
6719 This is closely related to the macro `HARD_REGNO_NREGS'. In fact, the value
6720 of the macro `CLASS_MAX_NREGS (RCLASS, MODE)' should be the maximum value of
6721 `HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO, MODE)' for all REGNO values in the class RCLASS.
6723 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values in
6724 the reload pass.
6726 This declaration is required. */
6729 frv_class_max_nregs (enum reg_class rclass, enum machine_mode mode)
6731 if (rclass == ACCG_REGS)
6732 /* An N-byte value requires N accumulator guards. */
6733 return GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
6734 else
6735 return (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
6739 /* A C expression that is nonzero if X is a legitimate constant for an
6740 immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that X satisfies
6741 `CONSTANT_P', so you need not check this. In fact, `1' is a suitable
6742 definition for this macro on machines where anything `CONSTANT_P' is valid. */
6744 static bool
6745 frv_legitimate_constant_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x)
6747 /* frv_cannot_force_const_mem always returns true for FDPIC. This
6748 means that the move expanders will be expected to deal with most
6749 kinds of constant, regardless of what we return here.
6751 However, among its other duties, frv_legitimate_constant_p decides whether
6752 a constant can be entered into reg_equiv_constant[]. If we return true,
6753 reload can create new instances of the constant whenever it likes.
6755 The idea is therefore to accept as many constants as possible (to give
6756 reload more freedom) while rejecting constants that can only be created
6757 at certain times. In particular, anything with a symbolic component will
6758 require use of the pseudo FDPIC register, which is only available before
6759 reload. */
6760 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
6761 return LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (x);
6763 /* All of the integer constants are ok. */
6764 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_DOUBLE)
6765 return TRUE;
6767 /* double integer constants are ok. */
6768 if (GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode || mode == DImode)
6769 return TRUE;
6771 /* 0 is always ok. */
6772 if (x == CONST0_RTX (mode))
6773 return TRUE;
6775 /* If floating point is just emulated, allow any constant, since it will be
6776 constructed in the GPRs. */
6777 if (!TARGET_HAS_FPRS)
6778 return TRUE;
6780 if (mode == DFmode && !TARGET_DOUBLE)
6781 return TRUE;
6783 /* Otherwise store the constant away and do a load. */
6784 return FALSE;
6787 /* Implement SELECT_CC_MODE. Choose CC_FP for floating-point comparisons,
6788 CC_NZ for comparisons against zero in which a single Z or N flag test
6789 is enough, CC_UNS for other unsigned comparisons, and CC for other
6790 signed comparisons. */
6792 enum machine_mode
6793 frv_select_cc_mode (enum rtx_code code, rtx x, rtx y)
6795 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) == MODE_FLOAT)
6796 return CC_FPmode;
6798 switch (code)
6800 case EQ:
6801 case NE:
6802 case LT:
6803 case GE:
6804 return y == const0_rtx ? CC_NZmode : CCmode;
6806 case GTU:
6807 case GEU:
6808 case LTU:
6809 case LEU:
6810 return y == const0_rtx ? CC_NZmode : CC_UNSmode;
6812 default:
6813 return CCmode;
6818 /* Worker function for TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST. */
6820 #define HIGH_COST 40
6821 #define MEDIUM_COST 3
6822 #define LOW_COST 1
6824 static int
6825 frv_register_move_cost (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6826 reg_class_t from, reg_class_t to)
6828 switch (from)
6830 default:
6831 break;
6833 case QUAD_REGS:
6834 case GPR_REGS:
6835 case GR8_REGS:
6836 case GR9_REGS:
6837 case GR89_REGS:
6838 case FDPIC_REGS:
6839 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6840 case FDPIC_CALL_REGS:
6842 switch (to)
6844 default:
6845 break;
6847 case QUAD_REGS:
6848 case GPR_REGS:
6849 case GR8_REGS:
6850 case GR9_REGS:
6851 case GR89_REGS:
6852 case FDPIC_REGS:
6853 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6854 case FDPIC_CALL_REGS:
6856 return LOW_COST;
6858 case FPR_REGS:
6859 return LOW_COST;
6861 case LCR_REG:
6862 case LR_REG:
6863 case SPR_REGS:
6864 return LOW_COST;
6867 case QUAD_FPR_REGS:
6868 switch (to)
6870 default:
6871 break;
6873 case QUAD_REGS:
6874 case GPR_REGS:
6875 case GR8_REGS:
6876 case GR9_REGS:
6877 case GR89_REGS:
6878 case FDPIC_REGS:
6879 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6880 case FDPIC_CALL_REGS:
6882 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
6883 case ACCG_REGS:
6884 return MEDIUM_COST;
6886 case QUAD_FPR_REGS:
6887 return LOW_COST;
6890 case LCR_REG:
6891 case LR_REG:
6892 case SPR_REGS:
6893 switch (to)
6895 default:
6896 break;
6898 case QUAD_REGS:
6899 case GPR_REGS:
6900 case GR8_REGS:
6901 case GR9_REGS:
6902 case GR89_REGS:
6903 case FDPIC_REGS:
6904 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6905 case FDPIC_CALL_REGS:
6907 return MEDIUM_COST;
6910 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
6911 case ACCG_REGS:
6912 switch (to)
6914 default:
6915 break;
6917 case QUAD_FPR_REGS:
6918 return MEDIUM_COST;
6923 return HIGH_COST;
6926 /* Worker function for TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST. */
6928 static int
6929 frv_memory_move_cost (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6930 reg_class_t rclass ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6931 bool in ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6933 return 4;
6937 /* Implementation of TARGET_ASM_INTEGER. In the FRV case we need to
6938 use ".picptr" to generate safe relocations for PIC code. We also
6939 need a fixup entry for aligned (non-debugging) code. */
6941 static bool
6942 frv_assemble_integer (rtx value, unsigned int size, int aligned_p)
6944 if ((flag_pic || TARGET_FDPIC) && size == UNITS_PER_WORD)
6946 if (GET_CODE (value) == CONST
6947 || GET_CODE (value) == SYMBOL_REF
6948 || GET_CODE (value) == LABEL_REF)
6950 if (TARGET_FDPIC && GET_CODE (value) == SYMBOL_REF
6951 && SYMBOL_REF_FUNCTION_P (value))
6953 fputs ("\t.picptr\tfuncdesc(", asm_out_file);
6954 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, value);
6955 fputs (")\n", asm_out_file);
6956 return true;
6958 else if (TARGET_FDPIC && GET_CODE (value) == CONST
6959 && frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (value))
6960 return false;
6961 if (aligned_p && !TARGET_FDPIC)
6963 static int label_num = 0;
6964 char buf[256];
6965 const char *p;
6967 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, "LCP", label_num++);
6968 p = (* targetm.strip_name_encoding) (buf);
6970 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s:\n", p);
6971 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s\n", FIXUP_SECTION_ASM_OP);
6972 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.picptr\t%s\n", p);
6973 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.previous\n");
6975 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.picptr\t", value);
6976 return true;
6978 if (!aligned_p)
6980 /* We've set the unaligned SI op to NULL, so we always have to
6981 handle the unaligned case here. */
6982 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.4byte\t", value);
6983 return true;
6986 return default_assemble_integer (value, size, aligned_p);
6989 /* Function to set up the backend function structure. */
6991 static struct machine_function *
6992 frv_init_machine_status (void)
6994 return ggc_cleared_alloc<machine_function> ();
6997 /* Implement TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE. */
7000 frv_issue_rate (void)
7002 if (!TARGET_PACK)
7003 return 1;
7005 switch (frv_cpu_type)
7007 default:
7008 case FRV_CPU_FR300:
7009 case FRV_CPU_SIMPLE:
7010 return 1;
7012 case FRV_CPU_FR400:
7013 case FRV_CPU_FR405:
7014 case FRV_CPU_FR450:
7015 return 2;
7017 case FRV_CPU_GENERIC:
7018 case FRV_CPU_FR500:
7019 case FRV_CPU_TOMCAT:
7020 return 4;
7022 case FRV_CPU_FR550:
7023 return 8;
7027 /* A for_each_rtx callback. If X refers to an accumulator, return
7028 ACC_GROUP_ODD if the bit 2 of the register number is set and
7029 ACC_GROUP_EVEN if it is clear. Return 0 (ACC_GROUP_NONE)
7030 otherwise. */
7032 static int
7033 frv_acc_group_1 (rtx *x, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7035 if (REG_P (*x))
7037 if (ACC_P (REGNO (*x)))
7038 return (REGNO (*x) - ACC_FIRST) & 4 ? ACC_GROUP_ODD : ACC_GROUP_EVEN;
7039 if (ACCG_P (REGNO (*x)))
7040 return (REGNO (*x) - ACCG_FIRST) & 4 ? ACC_GROUP_ODD : ACC_GROUP_EVEN;
7042 return 0;
7045 /* Return the value of INSN's acc_group attribute. */
7048 frv_acc_group (rtx insn)
7050 /* This distinction only applies to the FR550 packing constraints. */
7051 if (frv_cpu_type != FRV_CPU_FR550)
7052 return ACC_GROUP_NONE;
7053 return for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), frv_acc_group_1, 0);
7056 /* Return the index of the DFA unit in FRV_UNIT_NAMES[] that instruction
7057 INSN will try to claim first. Since this value depends only on the
7058 type attribute, we can cache the results in FRV_TYPE_TO_UNIT[]. */
7060 static unsigned int
7061 frv_insn_unit (rtx insn)
7063 enum attr_type type;
7065 type = get_attr_type (insn);
7066 if (frv_type_to_unit[type] == ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes))
7068 /* We haven't seen this type of instruction before. */
7069 state_t state;
7070 unsigned int unit;
7072 /* Issue the instruction on its own to see which unit it prefers. */
7073 state = alloca (state_size ());
7074 state_reset (state);
7075 state_transition (state, insn);
7077 /* Find out which unit was taken. */
7078 for (unit = 0; unit < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes); unit++)
7079 if (cpu_unit_reservation_p (state, frv_unit_codes[unit]))
7080 break;
7082 gcc_assert (unit != ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes));
7084 frv_type_to_unit[type] = unit;
7086 return frv_type_to_unit[type];
7089 /* Return true if INSN issues to a branch unit. */
7091 static bool
7092 frv_issues_to_branch_unit_p (rtx insn)
7094 return frv_unit_groups[frv_insn_unit (insn)] == GROUP_B;
7097 /* The instructions in the packet, partitioned into groups. */
7098 struct frv_packet_group {
7099 /* How many instructions in the packet belong to this group. */
7100 unsigned int num_insns;
7102 /* A list of the instructions that belong to this group, in the order
7103 they appear in the rtl stream. */
7104 rtx_insn *insns[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes)];
7106 /* The contents of INSNS after they have been sorted into the correct
7107 assembly-language order. Element X issues to unit X. The list may
7108 contain extra nops. */
7109 rtx_insn *sorted[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes)];
7111 /* The member of frv_nops[] to use in sorted[]. */
7112 rtx_insn *nop;
7115 /* The current state of the packing pass, implemented by frv_pack_insns. */
7116 static struct {
7117 /* The state of the pipeline DFA. */
7118 state_t dfa_state;
7120 /* Which hardware registers are set within the current packet,
7121 and the conditions under which they are set. */
7122 regstate_t regstate[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
7124 /* The memory locations that have been modified so far in this
7125 packet. MEM is the memref and COND is the regstate_t condition
7126 under which it is set. */
7127 struct {
7128 rtx mem;
7129 regstate_t cond;
7130 } mems[2];
7132 /* The number of valid entries in MEMS. The value is larger than
7133 ARRAY_SIZE (mems) if there were too many mems to record. */
7134 unsigned int num_mems;
7136 /* The maximum number of instructions that can be packed together. */
7137 unsigned int issue_rate;
7139 /* The instructions in the packet, partitioned into groups. */
7140 struct frv_packet_group groups[NUM_GROUPS];
7142 /* The instructions that make up the current packet. */
7143 rtx_insn *insns[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes)];
7144 unsigned int num_insns;
7145 } frv_packet;
7147 /* Return the regstate_t flags for the given COND_EXEC condition.
7148 Abort if the condition isn't in the right form. */
7150 static int
7151 frv_cond_flags (rtx cond)
7153 gcc_assert ((GET_CODE (cond) == EQ || GET_CODE (cond) == NE)
7154 && GET_CODE (XEXP (cond, 0)) == REG
7155 && CR_P (REGNO (XEXP (cond, 0)))
7156 && XEXP (cond, 1) == const0_rtx);
7157 return ((REGNO (XEXP (cond, 0)) - CR_FIRST)
7158 | (GET_CODE (cond) == NE
7159 ? REGSTATE_IF_TRUE
7160 : REGSTATE_IF_FALSE));
7164 /* Return true if something accessed under condition COND2 can
7165 conflict with something written under condition COND1. */
7167 static bool
7168 frv_regstate_conflict_p (regstate_t cond1, regstate_t cond2)
7170 /* If either reference was unconditional, we have a conflict. */
7171 if ((cond1 & REGSTATE_IF_EITHER) == 0
7172 || (cond2 & REGSTATE_IF_EITHER) == 0)
7173 return true;
7175 /* The references might conflict if they were controlled by
7176 different CRs. */
7177 if ((cond1 & REGSTATE_CC_MASK) != (cond2 & REGSTATE_CC_MASK))
7178 return true;
7180 /* They definitely conflict if they are controlled by the
7181 same condition. */
7182 if ((cond1 & cond2 & REGSTATE_IF_EITHER) != 0)
7183 return true;
7185 return false;
7189 /* A for_each_rtx callback. Return 1 if *X depends on an instruction in
7190 the current packet. DATA points to a regstate_t that describes the
7191 condition under which *X might be set or used. */
7193 static int
7194 frv_registers_conflict_p_1 (rtx *x, void *data)
7196 unsigned int regno, i;
7197 regstate_t cond;
7199 cond = *(regstate_t *) data;
7201 if (GET_CODE (*x) == REG)
7202 FOR_EACH_REGNO (regno, *x)
7203 if ((frv_packet.regstate[regno] & REGSTATE_MODIFIED) != 0)
7204 if (frv_regstate_conflict_p (frv_packet.regstate[regno], cond))
7205 return 1;
7207 if (GET_CODE (*x) == MEM)
7209 /* If we ran out of memory slots, assume a conflict. */
7210 if (frv_packet.num_mems > ARRAY_SIZE (frv_packet.mems))
7211 return 1;
7213 /* Check for output or true dependencies with earlier MEMs. */
7214 for (i = 0; i < frv_packet.num_mems; i++)
7215 if (frv_regstate_conflict_p (frv_packet.mems[i].cond, cond))
7217 if (true_dependence (frv_packet.mems[i].mem, VOIDmode, *x))
7218 return 1;
7220 if (output_dependence (frv_packet.mems[i].mem, *x))
7221 return 1;
7225 /* The return values of calls aren't significant: they describe
7226 the effect of the call as a whole, not of the insn itself. */
7227 if (GET_CODE (*x) == SET && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (*x)) == CALL)
7229 if (for_each_rtx (&SET_SRC (*x), frv_registers_conflict_p_1, data))
7230 return 1;
7231 return -1;
7234 /* Check subexpressions. */
7235 return 0;
7239 /* Return true if something in X might depend on an instruction
7240 in the current packet. */
7242 static bool
7243 frv_registers_conflict_p (rtx x)
7245 regstate_t flags;
7247 flags = 0;
7248 if (GET_CODE (x) == COND_EXEC)
7250 if (for_each_rtx (&XEXP (x, 0), frv_registers_conflict_p_1, &flags))
7251 return true;
7253 flags |= frv_cond_flags (XEXP (x, 0));
7254 x = XEXP (x, 1);
7256 return for_each_rtx (&x, frv_registers_conflict_p_1, &flags);
7260 /* A note_stores callback. DATA points to the regstate_t condition
7261 under which X is modified. Update FRV_PACKET accordingly. */
7263 static void
7264 frv_registers_update_1 (rtx x, const_rtx pat ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data)
7266 unsigned int regno;
7268 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
7269 FOR_EACH_REGNO (regno, x)
7270 frv_packet.regstate[regno] |= *(regstate_t *) data;
7272 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
7274 if (frv_packet.num_mems < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_packet.mems))
7276 frv_packet.mems[frv_packet.num_mems].mem = x;
7277 frv_packet.mems[frv_packet.num_mems].cond = *(regstate_t *) data;
7279 frv_packet.num_mems++;
7284 /* Update the register state information for an instruction whose
7285 body is X. */
7287 static void
7288 frv_registers_update (rtx x)
7290 regstate_t flags;
7292 flags = REGSTATE_MODIFIED;
7293 if (GET_CODE (x) == COND_EXEC)
7295 flags |= frv_cond_flags (XEXP (x, 0));
7296 x = XEXP (x, 1);
7298 note_stores (x, frv_registers_update_1, &flags);
7302 /* Initialize frv_packet for the start of a new packet. */
7304 static void
7305 frv_start_packet (void)
7307 enum frv_insn_group group;
7309 memset (frv_packet.regstate, 0, sizeof (frv_packet.regstate));
7310 frv_packet.num_mems = 0;
7311 frv_packet.num_insns = 0;
7312 for (group = GROUP_I; group < NUM_GROUPS;
7313 group = (enum frv_insn_group) (group + 1))
7314 frv_packet.groups[group].num_insns = 0;
7318 /* Likewise for the start of a new basic block. */
7320 static void
7321 frv_start_packet_block (void)
7323 state_reset (frv_packet.dfa_state);
7324 frv_start_packet ();
7328 /* Finish the current packet, if any, and start a new one. Call
7329 HANDLE_PACKET with FRV_PACKET describing the completed packet. */
7331 static void
7332 frv_finish_packet (void (*handle_packet) (void))
7334 if (frv_packet.num_insns > 0)
7336 handle_packet ();
7337 state_transition (frv_packet.dfa_state, 0);
7338 frv_start_packet ();
7343 /* Return true if INSN can be added to the current packet. Update
7344 the DFA state on success. */
7346 static bool
7347 frv_pack_insn_p (rtx insn)
7349 /* See if the packet is already as long as it can be. */
7350 if (frv_packet.num_insns == frv_packet.issue_rate)
7351 return false;
7353 /* If the scheduler thought that an instruction should start a packet,
7354 it's usually a good idea to believe it. It knows much more about
7355 the latencies than we do.
7357 There are some exceptions though:
7359 - Conditional instructions are scheduled on the assumption that
7360 they will be executed. This is usually a good thing, since it
7361 tends to avoid unnecessary stalls in the conditional code.
7362 But we want to pack conditional instructions as tightly as
7363 possible, in order to optimize the case where they aren't
7364 executed.
7366 - The scheduler will always put branches on their own, even
7367 if there's no real dependency.
7369 - There's no point putting a call in its own packet unless
7370 we have to. */
7371 if (frv_packet.num_insns > 0
7372 && NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn)
7373 && GET_MODE (insn) == TImode
7374 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != COND_EXEC)
7375 return false;
7377 /* Check for register conflicts. Don't do this for setlo since any
7378 conflict will be with the partnering sethi, with which it can
7379 be packed. */
7380 if (get_attr_type (insn) != TYPE_SETLO)
7381 if (frv_registers_conflict_p (PATTERN (insn)))
7382 return false;
7384 return state_transition (frv_packet.dfa_state, insn) < 0;
7388 /* Add instruction INSN to the current packet. */
7390 static void
7391 frv_add_insn_to_packet (rtx_insn *insn)
7393 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7395 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[frv_unit_groups[frv_insn_unit (insn)]];
7396 packet_group->insns[packet_group->num_insns++] = insn;
7397 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns++] = insn;
7399 frv_registers_update (PATTERN (insn));
7403 /* Insert INSN (a member of frv_nops[]) into the current packet. If the
7404 packet ends in a branch or call, insert the nop before it, otherwise
7405 add to the end. */
7407 static void
7408 frv_insert_nop_in_packet (rtx_insn *insn)
7410 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7411 rtx_insn *last;
7413 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[frv_unit_groups[frv_insn_unit (insn)]];
7414 last = frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1];
7415 if (! NONJUMP_INSN_P (last))
7417 insn = emit_insn_before (PATTERN (insn), last);
7418 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1] = insn;
7419 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns++] = last;
7421 else
7423 insn = emit_insn_after (PATTERN (insn), last);
7424 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns++] = insn;
7426 packet_group->insns[packet_group->num_insns++] = insn;
7430 /* If packing is enabled, divide the instructions into packets and
7431 return true. Call HANDLE_PACKET for each complete packet. */
7433 static bool
7434 frv_for_each_packet (void (*handle_packet) (void))
7436 rtx_insn *insn, *next_insn;
7438 frv_packet.issue_rate = frv_issue_rate ();
7440 /* Early exit if we don't want to pack insns. */
7441 if (!optimize
7442 || !flag_schedule_insns_after_reload
7443 || !TARGET_VLIW_BRANCH
7444 || frv_packet.issue_rate == 1)
7445 return false;
7447 /* Set up the initial packing state. */
7448 dfa_start ();
7449 frv_packet.dfa_state = alloca (state_size ());
7451 frv_start_packet_block ();
7452 for (insn = get_insns (); insn != 0; insn = next_insn)
7454 enum rtx_code code;
7455 bool eh_insn_p;
7457 code = GET_CODE (insn);
7458 next_insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
7460 if (code == CODE_LABEL)
7462 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7463 frv_start_packet_block ();
7466 if (INSN_P (insn))
7467 switch (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)))
7469 case USE:
7470 case CLOBBER:
7471 break;
7473 default:
7474 /* Calls mustn't be packed on a TOMCAT. */
7475 if (CALL_P (insn) && frv_cpu_type == FRV_CPU_TOMCAT)
7476 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7478 /* Since the last instruction in a packet determines the EH
7479 region, any exception-throwing instruction must come at
7480 the end of reordered packet. Insns that issue to a
7481 branch unit are bound to come last; for others it's
7482 too hard to predict. */
7483 eh_insn_p = (find_reg_note (insn, REG_EH_REGION, NULL) != NULL);
7484 if (eh_insn_p && !frv_issues_to_branch_unit_p (insn))
7485 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7487 /* Finish the current packet if we can't add INSN to it.
7488 Simulate cycles until INSN is ready to issue. */
7489 if (!frv_pack_insn_p (insn))
7491 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7492 while (!frv_pack_insn_p (insn))
7493 state_transition (frv_packet.dfa_state, 0);
7496 /* Add the instruction to the packet. */
7497 frv_add_insn_to_packet (insn);
7499 /* Calls and jumps end a packet, as do insns that throw
7500 an exception. */
7501 if (code == CALL_INSN || code == JUMP_INSN || eh_insn_p)
7502 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7503 break;
7506 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7507 dfa_finish ();
7508 return true;
7511 /* Subroutine of frv_sort_insn_group. We are trying to sort
7512 frv_packet.groups[GROUP].sorted[0...NUM_INSNS-1] into assembly
7513 language order. We have already picked a new position for
7514 frv_packet.groups[GROUP].sorted[X] if bit X of ISSUED is set.
7515 These instructions will occupy elements [0, LOWER_SLOT) and
7516 [UPPER_SLOT, NUM_INSNS) of the final (sorted) array. STATE is
7517 the DFA state after issuing these instructions.
7519 Try filling elements [LOWER_SLOT, UPPER_SLOT) with every permutation
7520 of the unused instructions. Return true if one such permutation gives
7521 a valid ordering, leaving the successful permutation in sorted[].
7522 Do not modify sorted[] until a valid permutation is found. */
7524 static bool
7525 frv_sort_insn_group_1 (enum frv_insn_group group,
7526 unsigned int lower_slot, unsigned int upper_slot,
7527 unsigned int issued, unsigned int num_insns,
7528 state_t state)
7530 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7531 unsigned int i;
7532 state_t test_state;
7533 size_t dfa_size;
7534 rtx_insn *insn;
7536 /* Early success if we've filled all the slots. */
7537 if (lower_slot == upper_slot)
7538 return true;
7540 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
7541 dfa_size = state_size ();
7542 test_state = alloca (dfa_size);
7544 /* Try issuing each unused instruction. */
7545 for (i = num_insns - 1; i + 1 != 0; i--)
7546 if (~issued & (1 << i))
7548 insn = packet_group->sorted[i];
7549 memcpy (test_state, state, dfa_size);
7550 if (state_transition (test_state, insn) < 0
7551 && cpu_unit_reservation_p (test_state,
7552 NTH_UNIT (group, upper_slot - 1))
7553 && frv_sort_insn_group_1 (group, lower_slot, upper_slot - 1,
7554 issued | (1 << i), num_insns,
7555 test_state))
7557 packet_group->sorted[upper_slot - 1] = insn;
7558 return true;
7562 return false;
7565 /* Compare two instructions by their frv_insn_unit. */
7567 static int
7568 frv_compare_insns (const void *first, const void *second)
7570 const rtx *const insn1 = (rtx const *) first,
7571 *const insn2 = (rtx const *) second;
7572 return frv_insn_unit (*insn1) - frv_insn_unit (*insn2);
7575 /* Copy frv_packet.groups[GROUP].insns[] to frv_packet.groups[GROUP].sorted[]
7576 and sort it into assembly language order. See frv.md for a description of
7577 the algorithm. */
7579 static void
7580 frv_sort_insn_group (enum frv_insn_group group)
7582 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7583 unsigned int first, i, nop, max_unit, num_slots;
7584 state_t state, test_state;
7585 size_t dfa_size;
7587 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
7589 /* Assume no nop is needed. */
7590 packet_group->nop = 0;
7592 if (packet_group->num_insns == 0)
7593 return;
7595 /* Copy insns[] to sorted[]. */
7596 memcpy (packet_group->sorted, packet_group->insns,
7597 sizeof (rtx) * packet_group->num_insns);
7599 /* Sort sorted[] by the unit that each insn tries to take first. */
7600 if (packet_group->num_insns > 1)
7601 qsort (packet_group->sorted, packet_group->num_insns,
7602 sizeof (rtx), frv_compare_insns);
7604 /* That's always enough for branch and control insns. */
7605 if (group == GROUP_B || group == GROUP_C)
7606 return;
7608 dfa_size = state_size ();
7609 state = alloca (dfa_size);
7610 test_state = alloca (dfa_size);
7612 /* Find the highest FIRST such that sorted[0...FIRST-1] can issue
7613 consecutively and such that the DFA takes unit X when sorted[X]
7614 is added. Set STATE to the new DFA state. */
7615 state_reset (test_state);
7616 for (first = 0; first < packet_group->num_insns; first++)
7618 memcpy (state, test_state, dfa_size);
7619 if (state_transition (test_state, packet_group->sorted[first]) >= 0
7620 || !cpu_unit_reservation_p (test_state, NTH_UNIT (group, first)))
7621 break;
7624 /* If all the instructions issued in ascending order, we're done. */
7625 if (first == packet_group->num_insns)
7626 return;
7628 /* Add nops to the end of sorted[] and try each permutation until
7629 we find one that works. */
7630 for (nop = 0; nop < frv_num_nops; nop++)
7632 max_unit = frv_insn_unit (frv_nops[nop]);
7633 if (frv_unit_groups[max_unit] == group)
7635 packet_group->nop = frv_nops[nop];
7636 num_slots = UNIT_NUMBER (max_unit) + 1;
7637 for (i = packet_group->num_insns; i < num_slots; i++)
7638 packet_group->sorted[i] = frv_nops[nop];
7639 if (frv_sort_insn_group_1 (group, first, num_slots,
7640 (1 << first) - 1, num_slots, state))
7641 return;
7644 gcc_unreachable ();
7647 /* Sort the current packet into assembly-language order. Set packing
7648 flags as appropriate. */
7650 static void
7651 frv_reorder_packet (void)
7653 unsigned int cursor[NUM_GROUPS];
7654 rtx insns[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_groups)];
7655 unsigned int unit, to, from;
7656 enum frv_insn_group group;
7657 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7659 /* First sort each group individually. */
7660 for (group = GROUP_I; group < NUM_GROUPS;
7661 group = (enum frv_insn_group) (group + 1))
7663 cursor[group] = 0;
7664 frv_sort_insn_group (group);
7667 /* Go through the unit template and try add an instruction from
7668 that unit's group. */
7669 to = 0;
7670 for (unit = 0; unit < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_groups); unit++)
7672 group = frv_unit_groups[unit];
7673 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
7674 if (cursor[group] < packet_group->num_insns)
7676 /* frv_reorg should have added nops for us. */
7677 gcc_assert (packet_group->sorted[cursor[group]]
7678 != packet_group->nop);
7679 insns[to++] = packet_group->sorted[cursor[group]++];
7683 gcc_assert (to == frv_packet.num_insns);
7685 /* Clear the last instruction's packing flag, thus marking the end of
7686 a packet. Reorder the other instructions relative to it. */
7687 CLEAR_PACKING_FLAG (insns[to - 1]);
7688 for (from = 0; from < to - 1; from++)
7690 remove_insn (insns[from]);
7691 add_insn_before (insns[from], insns[to - 1], NULL);
7692 SET_PACKING_FLAG (insns[from]);
7697 /* Divide instructions into packets. Reorder the contents of each
7698 packet so that they are in the correct assembly-language order.
7700 Since this pass can change the raw meaning of the rtl stream, it must
7701 only be called at the last minute, just before the instructions are
7702 written out. */
7704 static void
7705 frv_pack_insns (void)
7707 if (frv_for_each_packet (frv_reorder_packet))
7708 frv_insn_packing_flag = 0;
7709 else
7710 frv_insn_packing_flag = -1;
7713 /* See whether we need to add nops to group GROUP in order to
7714 make a valid packet. */
7716 static void
7717 frv_fill_unused_units (enum frv_insn_group group)
7719 unsigned int non_nops, nops, i;
7720 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7722 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
7724 /* Sort the instructions into assembly-language order.
7725 Use nops to fill slots that are otherwise unused. */
7726 frv_sort_insn_group (group);
7728 /* See how many nops are needed before the final useful instruction. */
7729 i = nops = 0;
7730 for (non_nops = 0; non_nops < packet_group->num_insns; non_nops++)
7731 while (packet_group->sorted[i++] == packet_group->nop)
7732 nops++;
7734 /* Insert that many nops into the instruction stream. */
7735 while (nops-- > 0)
7736 frv_insert_nop_in_packet (packet_group->nop);
7739 /* Return true if accesses IO1 and IO2 refer to the same doubleword. */
7741 static bool
7742 frv_same_doubleword_p (const struct frv_io *io1, const struct frv_io *io2)
7744 if (io1->const_address != 0 && io2->const_address != 0)
7745 return io1->const_address == io2->const_address;
7747 if (io1->var_address != 0 && io2->var_address != 0)
7748 return rtx_equal_p (io1->var_address, io2->var_address);
7750 return false;
7753 /* Return true if operations IO1 and IO2 are guaranteed to complete
7754 in order. */
7756 static bool
7757 frv_io_fixed_order_p (const struct frv_io *io1, const struct frv_io *io2)
7759 /* The order of writes is always preserved. */
7760 if (io1->type == FRV_IO_WRITE && io2->type == FRV_IO_WRITE)
7761 return true;
7763 /* The order of reads isn't preserved. */
7764 if (io1->type != FRV_IO_WRITE && io2->type != FRV_IO_WRITE)
7765 return false;
7767 /* One operation is a write and the other is (or could be) a read.
7768 The order is only guaranteed if the accesses are to the same
7769 doubleword. */
7770 return frv_same_doubleword_p (io1, io2);
7773 /* Generalize I/O operation X so that it covers both X and Y. */
7775 static void
7776 frv_io_union (struct frv_io *x, const struct frv_io *y)
7778 if (x->type != y->type)
7779 x->type = FRV_IO_UNKNOWN;
7780 if (!frv_same_doubleword_p (x, y))
7782 x->const_address = 0;
7783 x->var_address = 0;
7787 /* Fill IO with information about the load or store associated with
7788 membar instruction INSN. */
7790 static void
7791 frv_extract_membar (struct frv_io *io, rtx_insn *insn)
7793 extract_insn (insn);
7794 io->type = (enum frv_io_type) INTVAL (recog_data.operand[2]);
7795 io->const_address = INTVAL (recog_data.operand[1]);
7796 io->var_address = XEXP (recog_data.operand[0], 0);
7799 /* A note_stores callback for which DATA points to an rtx. Nullify *DATA
7800 if X is a register and *DATA depends on X. */
7802 static void
7803 frv_io_check_address (rtx x, const_rtx pat ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data)
7805 rtx *other = (rtx *) data;
7807 if (REG_P (x) && *other != 0 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, *other))
7808 *other = 0;
7811 /* A note_stores callback for which DATA points to a HARD_REG_SET.
7812 Remove every modified register from the set. */
7814 static void
7815 frv_io_handle_set (rtx x, const_rtx pat ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data)
7817 HARD_REG_SET *set = (HARD_REG_SET *) data;
7818 unsigned int regno;
7820 if (REG_P (x))
7821 FOR_EACH_REGNO (regno, x)
7822 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (*set, regno);
7825 /* A for_each_rtx callback for which DATA points to a HARD_REG_SET.
7826 Add every register in *X to the set. */
7828 static int
7829 frv_io_handle_use_1 (rtx *x, void *data)
7831 HARD_REG_SET *set = (HARD_REG_SET *) data;
7832 unsigned int regno;
7834 if (REG_P (*x))
7835 FOR_EACH_REGNO (regno, *x)
7836 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*set, regno);
7838 return 0;
7841 /* A note_stores callback that applies frv_io_handle_use_1 to an
7842 entire rhs value. */
7844 static void
7845 frv_io_handle_use (rtx *x, void *data)
7847 for_each_rtx (x, frv_io_handle_use_1, data);
7850 /* Go through block BB looking for membars to remove. There are two
7851 cases where intra-block analysis is enough:
7853 - a membar is redundant if it occurs between two consecutive I/O
7854 operations and if those operations are guaranteed to complete
7855 in order.
7857 - a membar for a __builtin_read is redundant if the result is
7858 used before the next I/O operation is issued.
7860 If the last membar in the block could not be removed, and there
7861 are guaranteed to be no I/O operations between that membar and
7862 the end of the block, store the membar in *LAST_MEMBAR, otherwise
7863 store null.
7865 Describe the block's first I/O operation in *NEXT_IO. Describe
7866 an unknown operation if the block doesn't do any I/O. */
7868 static void
7869 frv_optimize_membar_local (basic_block bb, struct frv_io *next_io,
7870 rtx_insn **last_membar)
7872 HARD_REG_SET used_regs;
7873 rtx next_membar, set;
7874 rtx_insn *insn;
7875 bool next_is_end_p;
7877 /* NEXT_IO is the next I/O operation to be performed after the current
7878 instruction. It starts off as being an unknown operation. */
7879 memset (next_io, 0, sizeof (*next_io));
7881 /* NEXT_IS_END_P is true if NEXT_IO describes the end of the block. */
7882 next_is_end_p = true;
7884 /* If the current instruction is a __builtin_read or __builtin_write,
7885 NEXT_MEMBAR is the membar instruction associated with it. NEXT_MEMBAR
7886 is null if the membar has already been deleted.
7888 Note that the initialization here should only be needed to
7889 suppress warnings. */
7890 next_membar = 0;
7892 /* USED_REGS is the set of registers that are used before the
7893 next I/O instruction. */
7894 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_regs);
7896 for (insn = BB_END (bb); insn != BB_HEAD (bb); insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
7897 if (CALL_P (insn))
7899 /* We can't predict what a call will do to volatile memory. */
7900 memset (next_io, 0, sizeof (struct frv_io));
7901 next_is_end_p = false;
7902 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_regs);
7904 else if (INSN_P (insn))
7905 switch (recog_memoized (insn))
7907 case CODE_FOR_optional_membar_qi:
7908 case CODE_FOR_optional_membar_hi:
7909 case CODE_FOR_optional_membar_si:
7910 case CODE_FOR_optional_membar_di:
7911 next_membar = insn;
7912 if (next_is_end_p)
7914 /* Local information isn't enough to decide whether this
7915 membar is needed. Stash it away for later. */
7916 *last_membar = insn;
7917 frv_extract_membar (next_io, insn);
7918 next_is_end_p = false;
7920 else
7922 /* Check whether the I/O operation before INSN could be
7923 reordered with one described by NEXT_IO. If it can't,
7924 INSN will not be needed. */
7925 struct frv_io prev_io;
7927 frv_extract_membar (&prev_io, insn);
7928 if (frv_io_fixed_order_p (&prev_io, next_io))
7930 if (dump_file)
7931 fprintf (dump_file,
7932 ";; [Local] Removing membar %d since order"
7933 " of accesses is guaranteed\n",
7934 INSN_UID (next_membar));
7936 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
7937 delete_insn (next_membar);
7938 next_membar = 0;
7940 *next_io = prev_io;
7942 break;
7944 default:
7945 /* Invalidate NEXT_IO's address if it depends on something that
7946 is clobbered by INSN. */
7947 if (next_io->var_address)
7948 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), frv_io_check_address,
7949 &next_io->var_address);
7951 /* If the next membar is associated with a __builtin_read,
7952 see if INSN reads from that address. If it does, and if
7953 the destination register is used before the next I/O access,
7954 there is no need for the membar. */
7955 set = PATTERN (insn);
7956 if (next_io->type == FRV_IO_READ
7957 && next_io->var_address != 0
7958 && next_membar != 0
7959 && GET_CODE (set) == SET
7960 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == REG
7961 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_regs, REGNO (SET_DEST (set))))
7963 rtx src;
7965 src = SET_SRC (set);
7966 if (GET_CODE (src) == ZERO_EXTEND)
7967 src = XEXP (src, 0);
7969 if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM
7970 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (src, 0), next_io->var_address))
7972 if (dump_file)
7973 fprintf (dump_file,
7974 ";; [Local] Removing membar %d since the target"
7975 " of %d is used before the I/O operation\n",
7976 INSN_UID (next_membar), INSN_UID (insn));
7978 if (next_membar == *last_membar)
7979 *last_membar = 0;
7981 delete_insn (next_membar);
7982 next_membar = 0;
7986 /* If INSN has volatile references, forget about any registers
7987 that are used after it. Otherwise forget about uses that
7988 are (or might be) defined by INSN. */
7989 if (volatile_refs_p (PATTERN (insn)))
7990 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_regs);
7991 else
7992 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), frv_io_handle_set, &used_regs);
7994 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn), frv_io_handle_use, &used_regs);
7995 break;
7999 /* See if MEMBAR, the last membar instruction in BB, can be removed.
8000 FIRST_IO[X] describes the first operation performed by basic block X. */
8002 static void
8003 frv_optimize_membar_global (basic_block bb, struct frv_io *first_io,
8004 rtx_insn *membar)
8006 struct frv_io this_io, next_io;
8007 edge succ;
8008 edge_iterator ei;
8010 /* We need to keep the membar if there is an edge to the exit block. */
8011 FOR_EACH_EDGE (succ, ei, bb->succs)
8012 /* for (succ = bb->succ; succ != 0; succ = succ->succ_next) */
8013 if (succ->dest == EXIT_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun))
8014 return;
8016 /* Work out the union of all successor blocks. */
8017 ei = ei_start (bb->succs);
8018 ei_cond (ei, &succ);
8019 /* next_io = first_io[bb->succ->dest->index]; */
8020 next_io = first_io[succ->dest->index];
8021 ei = ei_start (bb->succs);
8022 if (ei_cond (ei, &succ))
8024 for (ei_next (&ei); ei_cond (ei, &succ); ei_next (&ei))
8025 /*for (succ = bb->succ->succ_next; succ != 0; succ = succ->succ_next)*/
8026 frv_io_union (&next_io, &first_io[succ->dest->index]);
8028 else
8029 gcc_unreachable ();
8031 frv_extract_membar (&this_io, membar);
8032 if (frv_io_fixed_order_p (&this_io, &next_io))
8034 if (dump_file)
8035 fprintf (dump_file,
8036 ";; [Global] Removing membar %d since order of accesses"
8037 " is guaranteed\n", INSN_UID (membar));
8039 delete_insn (membar);
8043 /* Remove redundant membars from the current function. */
8045 static void
8046 frv_optimize_membar (void)
8048 basic_block bb;
8049 struct frv_io *first_io;
8050 rtx_insn **last_membar;
8052 compute_bb_for_insn ();
8053 first_io = XCNEWVEC (struct frv_io, last_basic_block_for_fn (cfun));
8054 last_membar = XCNEWVEC (rtx_insn *, last_basic_block_for_fn (cfun));
8056 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
8057 frv_optimize_membar_local (bb, &first_io[bb->index],
8058 &last_membar[bb->index]);
8060 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
8061 if (last_membar[bb->index] != 0)
8062 frv_optimize_membar_global (bb, first_io, last_membar[bb->index]);
8064 free (first_io);
8065 free (last_membar);
8068 /* Used by frv_reorg to keep track of the current packet's address. */
8069 static unsigned int frv_packet_address;
8071 /* If the current packet falls through to a label, try to pad the packet
8072 with nops in order to fit the label's alignment requirements. */
8074 static void
8075 frv_align_label (void)
8077 unsigned int alignment, target, nop;
8078 rtx_insn *x, *last, *barrier, *label;
8080 /* Walk forward to the start of the next packet. Set ALIGNMENT to the
8081 maximum alignment of that packet, LABEL to the last label between
8082 the packets, and BARRIER to the last barrier. */
8083 last = frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1];
8084 label = barrier = 0;
8085 alignment = 4;
8086 for (x = NEXT_INSN (last); x != 0 && !INSN_P (x); x = NEXT_INSN (x))
8088 if (LABEL_P (x))
8090 unsigned int subalign = 1 << label_to_alignment (x);
8091 alignment = MAX (alignment, subalign);
8092 label = x;
8094 if (BARRIER_P (x))
8095 barrier = x;
8098 /* If -malign-labels, and the packet falls through to an unaligned
8099 label, try introducing a nop to align that label to 8 bytes. */
8100 if (TARGET_ALIGN_LABELS
8101 && label != 0
8102 && barrier == 0
8103 && frv_packet.num_insns < frv_packet.issue_rate)
8104 alignment = MAX (alignment, 8);
8106 /* Advance the address to the end of the current packet. */
8107 frv_packet_address += frv_packet.num_insns * 4;
8109 /* Work out the target address, after alignment. */
8110 target = (frv_packet_address + alignment - 1) & -alignment;
8112 /* If the packet falls through to the label, try to find an efficient
8113 padding sequence. */
8114 if (barrier == 0)
8116 /* First try adding nops to the current packet. */
8117 for (nop = 0; nop < frv_num_nops; nop++)
8118 while (frv_packet_address < target && frv_pack_insn_p (frv_nops[nop]))
8120 frv_insert_nop_in_packet (frv_nops[nop]);
8121 frv_packet_address += 4;
8124 /* If we still haven't reached the target, add some new packets that
8125 contain only nops. If there are two types of nop, insert an
8126 alternating sequence of frv_nops[0] and frv_nops[1], which will
8127 lead to packets like:
8129 nop.p
8130 mnop.p/fnop.p
8131 nop.p
8132 mnop/fnop
8134 etc. Just emit frv_nops[0] if that's the only nop we have. */
8135 last = frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1];
8136 nop = 0;
8137 while (frv_packet_address < target)
8139 last = emit_insn_after (PATTERN (frv_nops[nop]), last);
8140 frv_packet_address += 4;
8141 if (frv_num_nops > 1)
8142 nop ^= 1;
8146 frv_packet_address = target;
8149 /* Subroutine of frv_reorg, called after each packet has been constructed
8150 in frv_packet. */
8152 static void
8153 frv_reorg_packet (void)
8155 frv_fill_unused_units (GROUP_I);
8156 frv_fill_unused_units (GROUP_FM);
8157 frv_align_label ();
8160 /* Add an instruction with pattern NOP to frv_nops[]. */
8162 static void
8163 frv_register_nop (rtx nop)
8165 rtx_insn *nop_insn = make_insn_raw (nop);
8166 SET_NEXT_INSN (nop_insn) = 0;
8167 SET_PREV_INSN (nop_insn) = 0;
8168 frv_nops[frv_num_nops++] = nop_insn;
8171 /* Implement TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG. Divide the instructions
8172 into packets and check whether we need to insert nops in order to
8173 fulfill the processor's issue requirements. Also, if the user has
8174 requested a certain alignment for a label, try to meet that alignment
8175 by inserting nops in the previous packet. */
8177 static void
8178 frv_reorg (void)
8180 if (optimize > 0 && TARGET_OPTIMIZE_MEMBAR && cfun->machine->has_membar_p)
8181 frv_optimize_membar ();
8183 frv_num_nops = 0;
8184 frv_register_nop (gen_nop ());
8185 if (TARGET_MEDIA)
8186 frv_register_nop (gen_mnop ());
8187 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT)
8188 frv_register_nop (gen_fnop ());
8190 /* Estimate the length of each branch. Although this may change after
8191 we've inserted nops, it will only do so in big functions. */
8192 shorten_branches (get_insns ());
8194 frv_packet_address = 0;
8195 frv_for_each_packet (frv_reorg_packet);
8198 #define def_builtin(name, type, code) \
8199 add_builtin_function ((name), (type), (code), BUILT_IN_MD, NULL, NULL)
8201 struct builtin_description
8203 enum insn_code icode;
8204 const char *name;
8205 enum frv_builtins code;
8206 enum rtx_code comparison;
8207 unsigned int flag;
8210 /* Media intrinsics that take a single, constant argument. */
8212 static struct builtin_description bdesc_set[] =
8214 { CODE_FOR_mhdsets, "__MHDSETS", FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETS, UNKNOWN, 0 }
8217 /* Media intrinsics that take just one argument. */
8219 static struct builtin_description bdesc_1arg[] =
8221 { CODE_FOR_mnot, "__MNOT", FRV_BUILTIN_MNOT, UNKNOWN, 0 },
8222 { CODE_FOR_munpackh, "__MUNPACKH", FRV_BUILTIN_MUNPACKH, UNKNOWN, 0 },
8223 { CODE_FOR_mbtoh, "__MBTOH", FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOH, UNKNOWN, 0 },
8224 { CODE_FOR_mhtob, "__MHTOB", FRV_BUILTIN_MHTOB, UNKNOWN, 0},
8225 { CODE_FOR_mabshs, "__MABSHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MABSHS, UNKNOWN, 0 },
8226 { CODE_FOR_scutss, "__SCUTSS", FRV_BUILTIN_SCUTSS, UNKNOWN, 0 }
8229 /* Media intrinsics that take two arguments. */
8231 static struct builtin_description bdesc_2arg[] =
8233 { CODE_FOR_mand, "__MAND", FRV_BUILTIN_MAND, UNKNOWN, 0},
8234 { CODE_FOR_mor, "__MOR", FRV_BUILTIN_MOR, UNKNOWN, 0},
8235 { CODE_FOR_mxor, "__MXOR", FRV_BUILTIN_MXOR, UNKNOWN, 0},
8236 { CODE_FOR_maveh, "__MAVEH", FRV_BUILTIN_MAVEH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8237 { CODE_FOR_msaths, "__MSATHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8238 { CODE_FOR_msathu, "__MSATHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8239 { CODE_FOR_maddhss, "__MADDHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8240 { CODE_FOR_maddhus, "__MADDHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHUS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8241 { CODE_FOR_msubhss, "__MSUBHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8242 { CODE_FOR_msubhus, "__MSUBHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHUS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8243 { CODE_FOR_mqaddhss, "__MQADDHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8244 { CODE_FOR_mqaddhus, "__MQADDHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHUS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8245 { CODE_FOR_mqsubhss, "__MQSUBHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8246 { CODE_FOR_mqsubhus, "__MQSUBHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHUS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8247 { CODE_FOR_mpackh, "__MPACKH", FRV_BUILTIN_MPACKH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8248 { CODE_FOR_mcop1, "__Mcop1", FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP1, UNKNOWN, 0},
8249 { CODE_FOR_mcop2, "__Mcop2", FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP2, UNKNOWN, 0},
8250 { CODE_FOR_mwcut, "__MWCUT", FRV_BUILTIN_MWCUT, UNKNOWN, 0},
8251 { CODE_FOR_mqsaths, "__MQSATHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSATHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8252 { CODE_FOR_mqlclrhs, "__MQLCLRHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQLCLRHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8253 { CODE_FOR_mqlmths, "__MQLMTHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQLMTHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8254 { CODE_FOR_smul, "__SMUL", FRV_BUILTIN_SMUL, UNKNOWN, 0},
8255 { CODE_FOR_umul, "__UMUL", FRV_BUILTIN_UMUL, UNKNOWN, 0},
8256 { CODE_FOR_addss, "__ADDSS", FRV_BUILTIN_ADDSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8257 { CODE_FOR_subss, "__SUBSS", FRV_BUILTIN_SUBSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8258 { CODE_FOR_slass, "__SLASS", FRV_BUILTIN_SLASS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8259 { CODE_FOR_scan, "__SCAN", FRV_BUILTIN_SCAN, UNKNOWN, 0}
8262 /* Integer intrinsics that take two arguments and have no return value. */
8264 static struct builtin_description bdesc_int_void2arg[] =
8266 { CODE_FOR_smass, "__SMASS", FRV_BUILTIN_SMASS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8267 { CODE_FOR_smsss, "__SMSSS", FRV_BUILTIN_SMSSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8268 { CODE_FOR_smu, "__SMU", FRV_BUILTIN_SMU, UNKNOWN, 0}
8271 static struct builtin_description bdesc_prefetches[] =
8273 { CODE_FOR_frv_prefetch0, "__data_prefetch0", FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH0, UNKNOWN,
8275 { CODE_FOR_frv_prefetch, "__data_prefetch", FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH, UNKNOWN, 0}
8278 /* Media intrinsics that take two arguments, the first being an ACC number. */
8280 static struct builtin_description bdesc_cut[] =
8282 { CODE_FOR_mcut, "__MCUT", FRV_BUILTIN_MCUT, UNKNOWN, 0},
8283 { CODE_FOR_mcutss, "__MCUTSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MCUTSS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8284 { CODE_FOR_mdcutssi, "__MDCUTSSI", FRV_BUILTIN_MDCUTSSI, UNKNOWN, 0}
8287 /* Two-argument media intrinsics with an immediate second argument. */
8289 static struct builtin_description bdesc_2argimm[] =
8291 { CODE_FOR_mrotli, "__MROTLI", FRV_BUILTIN_MROTLI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8292 { CODE_FOR_mrotri, "__MROTRI", FRV_BUILTIN_MROTRI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8293 { CODE_FOR_msllhi, "__MSLLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MSLLHI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8294 { CODE_FOR_msrlhi, "__MSRLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MSRLHI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8295 { CODE_FOR_msrahi, "__MSRAHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MSRAHI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8296 { CODE_FOR_mexpdhw, "__MEXPDHW", FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHW, UNKNOWN, 0},
8297 { CODE_FOR_mexpdhd, "__MEXPDHD", FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHD, UNKNOWN, 0},
8298 { CODE_FOR_mdrotli, "__MDROTLI", FRV_BUILTIN_MDROTLI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8299 { CODE_FOR_mcplhi, "__MCPLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLHI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8300 { CODE_FOR_mcpli, "__MCPLI", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8301 { CODE_FOR_mhsetlos, "__MHSETLOS", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8302 { CODE_FOR_mhsetloh, "__MHSETLOH", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8303 { CODE_FOR_mhsethis, "__MHSETHIS", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8304 { CODE_FOR_mhsethih, "__MHSETHIH", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8305 { CODE_FOR_mhdseth, "__MHDSETH", FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8306 { CODE_FOR_mqsllhi, "__MQSLLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSLLHI, UNKNOWN, 0},
8307 { CODE_FOR_mqsrahi, "__MQSRAHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSRAHI, UNKNOWN, 0}
8310 /* Media intrinsics that take two arguments and return void, the first argument
8311 being a pointer to 4 words in memory. */
8313 static struct builtin_description bdesc_void2arg[] =
8315 { CODE_FOR_mdunpackh, "__MDUNPACKH", FRV_BUILTIN_MDUNPACKH, UNKNOWN, 0},
8316 { CODE_FOR_mbtohe, "__MBTOHE", FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOHE, UNKNOWN, 0},
8319 /* Media intrinsics that take three arguments, the first being a const_int that
8320 denotes an accumulator, and that return void. */
8322 static struct builtin_description bdesc_void3arg[] =
8324 { CODE_FOR_mcpxrs, "__MCPXRS", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8325 { CODE_FOR_mcpxru, "__MCPXRU", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8326 { CODE_FOR_mcpxis, "__MCPXIS", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8327 { CODE_FOR_mcpxiu, "__MCPXIU", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8328 { CODE_FOR_mmulhs, "__MMULHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8329 { CODE_FOR_mmulhu, "__MMULHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8330 { CODE_FOR_mmulxhs, "__MMULXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8331 { CODE_FOR_mmulxhu, "__MMULXHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8332 { CODE_FOR_mmachs, "__MMACHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8333 { CODE_FOR_mmachu, "__MMACHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8334 { CODE_FOR_mmrdhs, "__MMRDHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8335 { CODE_FOR_mmrdhu, "__MMRDHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8336 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxrs, "__MQCPXRS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8337 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxru, "__MQCPXRU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8338 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxis, "__MQCPXIS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8339 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxiu, "__MQCPXIU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8340 { CODE_FOR_mqmulhs, "__MQMULHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8341 { CODE_FOR_mqmulhu, "__MQMULHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8342 { CODE_FOR_mqmulxhs, "__MQMULXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8343 { CODE_FOR_mqmulxhu, "__MQMULXHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8344 { CODE_FOR_mqmachs, "__MQMACHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8345 { CODE_FOR_mqmachu, "__MQMACHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHU, UNKNOWN, 0},
8346 { CODE_FOR_mqxmachs, "__MQXMACHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8347 { CODE_FOR_mqxmacxhs, "__MQXMACXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACXHS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8348 { CODE_FOR_mqmacxhs, "__MQMACXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACXHS, UNKNOWN, 0}
8351 /* Media intrinsics that take two accumulator numbers as argument and
8352 return void. */
8354 static struct builtin_description bdesc_voidacc[] =
8356 { CODE_FOR_maddaccs, "__MADDACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MADDACCS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8357 { CODE_FOR_msubaccs, "__MSUBACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBACCS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8358 { CODE_FOR_masaccs, "__MASACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MASACCS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8359 { CODE_FOR_mdaddaccs, "__MDADDACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MDADDACCS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8360 { CODE_FOR_mdsubaccs, "__MDSUBACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MDSUBACCS, UNKNOWN, 0},
8361 { CODE_FOR_mdasaccs, "__MDASACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MDASACCS, UNKNOWN, 0}
8364 /* Intrinsics that load a value and then issue a MEMBAR. The load is
8365 a normal move and the ICODE is for the membar. */
8367 static struct builtin_description bdesc_loads[] =
8369 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_qi, "__builtin_read8",
8370 FRV_BUILTIN_READ8, UNKNOWN, 0},
8371 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_hi, "__builtin_read16",
8372 FRV_BUILTIN_READ16, UNKNOWN, 0},
8373 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_si, "__builtin_read32",
8374 FRV_BUILTIN_READ32, UNKNOWN, 0},
8375 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_di, "__builtin_read64",
8376 FRV_BUILTIN_READ64, UNKNOWN, 0}
8379 /* Likewise stores. */
8381 static struct builtin_description bdesc_stores[] =
8383 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_qi, "__builtin_write8",
8384 FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE8, UNKNOWN, 0},
8385 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_hi, "__builtin_write16",
8386 FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE16, UNKNOWN, 0},
8387 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_si, "__builtin_write32",
8388 FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE32, UNKNOWN, 0},
8389 { CODE_FOR_optional_membar_di, "__builtin_write64",
8390 FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE64, UNKNOWN, 0},
8393 /* Initialize media builtins. */
8395 static void
8396 frv_init_builtins (void)
8398 tree accumulator = integer_type_node;
8399 tree integer = integer_type_node;
8400 tree voidt = void_type_node;
8401 tree uhalf = short_unsigned_type_node;
8402 tree sword1 = long_integer_type_node;
8403 tree uword1 = long_unsigned_type_node;
8404 tree sword2 = long_long_integer_type_node;
8405 tree uword2 = long_long_unsigned_type_node;
8406 tree uword4 = build_pointer_type (uword1);
8407 tree vptr = build_pointer_type (build_type_variant (void_type_node, 0, 1));
8408 tree ubyte = unsigned_char_type_node;
8409 tree iacc = integer_type_node;
8411 #define UNARY(RET, T1) \
8412 build_function_type_list (RET, T1, NULL_TREE)
8414 #define BINARY(RET, T1, T2) \
8415 build_function_type_list (RET, T1, T2, NULL_TREE)
8417 #define TRINARY(RET, T1, T2, T3) \
8418 build_function_type_list (RET, T1, T2, T3, NULL_TREE)
8420 #define QUAD(RET, T1, T2, T3, T4) \
8421 build_function_type_list (RET, T1, T2, T3, T4, NULL_TREE)
8423 tree void_ftype_void = build_function_type_list (voidt, NULL_TREE);
8425 tree void_ftype_acc = UNARY (voidt, accumulator);
8426 tree void_ftype_uw4_uw1 = BINARY (voidt, uword4, uword1);
8427 tree void_ftype_uw4_uw2 = BINARY (voidt, uword4, uword2);
8428 tree void_ftype_acc_uw1 = BINARY (voidt, accumulator, uword1);
8429 tree void_ftype_acc_acc = BINARY (voidt, accumulator, accumulator);
8430 tree void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, uword1, uword1);
8431 tree void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, sword1, sword1);
8432 tree void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, uword2, uword2);
8433 tree void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, sword2, sword2);
8435 tree uw1_ftype_uw1 = UNARY (uword1, uword1);
8436 tree uw1_ftype_sw1 = UNARY (uword1, sword1);
8437 tree uw1_ftype_uw2 = UNARY (uword1, uword2);
8438 tree uw1_ftype_acc = UNARY (uword1, accumulator);
8439 tree uw1_ftype_uh_uh = BINARY (uword1, uhalf, uhalf);
8440 tree uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1 = BINARY (uword1, uword1, uword1);
8441 tree uw1_ftype_uw1_int = BINARY (uword1, uword1, integer);
8442 tree uw1_ftype_acc_uw1 = BINARY (uword1, accumulator, uword1);
8443 tree uw1_ftype_acc_sw1 = BINARY (uword1, accumulator, sword1);
8444 tree uw1_ftype_uw2_uw1 = BINARY (uword1, uword2, uword1);
8445 tree uw1_ftype_uw2_int = BINARY (uword1, uword2, integer);
8447 tree sw1_ftype_int = UNARY (sword1, integer);
8448 tree sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1 = BINARY (sword1, sword1, sword1);
8449 tree sw1_ftype_sw1_int = BINARY (sword1, sword1, integer);
8451 tree uw2_ftype_uw1 = UNARY (uword2, uword1);
8452 tree uw2_ftype_uw1_int = BINARY (uword2, uword1, integer);
8453 tree uw2_ftype_uw2_uw2 = BINARY (uword2, uword2, uword2);
8454 tree uw2_ftype_uw2_int = BINARY (uword2, uword2, integer);
8455 tree uw2_ftype_acc_int = BINARY (uword2, accumulator, integer);
8456 tree uw2_ftype_uh_uh_uh_uh = QUAD (uword2, uhalf, uhalf, uhalf, uhalf);
8458 tree sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2 = BINARY (sword2, sword2, sword2);
8459 tree sw2_ftype_sw2_int = BINARY (sword2, sword2, integer);
8460 tree uw2_ftype_uw1_uw1 = BINARY (uword2, uword1, uword1);
8461 tree sw2_ftype_sw1_sw1 = BINARY (sword2, sword1, sword1);
8462 tree void_ftype_sw1_sw1 = BINARY (voidt, sword1, sword1);
8463 tree void_ftype_iacc_sw2 = BINARY (voidt, iacc, sword2);
8464 tree void_ftype_iacc_sw1 = BINARY (voidt, iacc, sword1);
8465 tree sw1_ftype_sw1 = UNARY (sword1, sword1);
8466 tree sw2_ftype_iacc = UNARY (sword2, iacc);
8467 tree sw1_ftype_iacc = UNARY (sword1, iacc);
8468 tree void_ftype_ptr = UNARY (voidt, const_ptr_type_node);
8469 tree uw1_ftype_vptr = UNARY (uword1, vptr);
8470 tree uw2_ftype_vptr = UNARY (uword2, vptr);
8471 tree void_ftype_vptr_ub = BINARY (voidt, vptr, ubyte);
8472 tree void_ftype_vptr_uh = BINARY (voidt, vptr, uhalf);
8473 tree void_ftype_vptr_uw1 = BINARY (voidt, vptr, uword1);
8474 tree void_ftype_vptr_uw2 = BINARY (voidt, vptr, uword2);
8476 def_builtin ("__MAND", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MAND);
8477 def_builtin ("__MOR", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MOR);
8478 def_builtin ("__MXOR", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MXOR);
8479 def_builtin ("__MNOT", uw1_ftype_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MNOT);
8480 def_builtin ("__MROTLI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MROTLI);
8481 def_builtin ("__MROTRI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MROTRI);
8482 def_builtin ("__MWCUT", uw1_ftype_uw2_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MWCUT);
8483 def_builtin ("__MAVEH", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MAVEH);
8484 def_builtin ("__MSLLHI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MSLLHI);
8485 def_builtin ("__MSRLHI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MSRLHI);
8486 def_builtin ("__MSRAHI", sw1_ftype_sw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MSRAHI);
8487 def_builtin ("__MSATHS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHS);
8488 def_builtin ("__MSATHU", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHU);
8489 def_builtin ("__MADDHSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHSS);
8490 def_builtin ("__MADDHUS", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHUS);
8491 def_builtin ("__MSUBHSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHSS);
8492 def_builtin ("__MSUBHUS", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHUS);
8493 def_builtin ("__MMULHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHS);
8494 def_builtin ("__MMULHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHU);
8495 def_builtin ("__MMULXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHS);
8496 def_builtin ("__MMULXHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHU);
8497 def_builtin ("__MMACHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHS);
8498 def_builtin ("__MMACHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHU);
8499 def_builtin ("__MMRDHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHS);
8500 def_builtin ("__MMRDHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHU);
8501 def_builtin ("__MQADDHSS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHSS);
8502 def_builtin ("__MQADDHUS", uw2_ftype_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHUS);
8503 def_builtin ("__MQSUBHSS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHSS);
8504 def_builtin ("__MQSUBHUS", uw2_ftype_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHUS);
8505 def_builtin ("__MQMULHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHS);
8506 def_builtin ("__MQMULHU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHU);
8507 def_builtin ("__MQMULXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHS);
8508 def_builtin ("__MQMULXHU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHU);
8509 def_builtin ("__MQMACHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHS);
8510 def_builtin ("__MQMACHU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHU);
8511 def_builtin ("__MCPXRS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRS);
8512 def_builtin ("__MCPXRU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRU);
8513 def_builtin ("__MCPXIS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIS);
8514 def_builtin ("__MCPXIU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIU);
8515 def_builtin ("__MQCPXRS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRS);
8516 def_builtin ("__MQCPXRU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRU);
8517 def_builtin ("__MQCPXIS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIS);
8518 def_builtin ("__MQCPXIU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIU);
8519 def_builtin ("__MCUT", uw1_ftype_acc_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCUT);
8520 def_builtin ("__MCUTSS", uw1_ftype_acc_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCUTSS);
8521 def_builtin ("__MEXPDHW", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHW);
8522 def_builtin ("__MEXPDHD", uw2_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHD);
8523 def_builtin ("__MPACKH", uw1_ftype_uh_uh, FRV_BUILTIN_MPACKH);
8524 def_builtin ("__MUNPACKH", uw2_ftype_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MUNPACKH);
8525 def_builtin ("__MDPACKH", uw2_ftype_uh_uh_uh_uh, FRV_BUILTIN_MDPACKH);
8526 def_builtin ("__MDUNPACKH", void_ftype_uw4_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MDUNPACKH);
8527 def_builtin ("__MBTOH", uw2_ftype_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOH);
8528 def_builtin ("__MHTOB", uw1_ftype_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MHTOB);
8529 def_builtin ("__MBTOHE", void_ftype_uw4_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOHE);
8530 def_builtin ("__MCLRACC", void_ftype_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACC);
8531 def_builtin ("__MCLRACCA", void_ftype_void, FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACCA);
8532 def_builtin ("__MRDACC", uw1_ftype_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACC);
8533 def_builtin ("__MRDACCG", uw1_ftype_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACCG);
8534 def_builtin ("__MWTACC", void_ftype_acc_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACC);
8535 def_builtin ("__MWTACCG", void_ftype_acc_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACCG);
8536 def_builtin ("__Mcop1", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP1);
8537 def_builtin ("__Mcop2", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP2);
8538 def_builtin ("__MTRAP", void_ftype_void, FRV_BUILTIN_MTRAP);
8539 def_builtin ("__MQXMACHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACHS);
8540 def_builtin ("__MQXMACXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACXHS);
8541 def_builtin ("__MQMACXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACXHS);
8542 def_builtin ("__MADDACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MADDACCS);
8543 def_builtin ("__MSUBACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBACCS);
8544 def_builtin ("__MASACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MASACCS);
8545 def_builtin ("__MDADDACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MDADDACCS);
8546 def_builtin ("__MDSUBACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MDSUBACCS);
8547 def_builtin ("__MDASACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MDASACCS);
8548 def_builtin ("__MABSHS", uw1_ftype_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MABSHS);
8549 def_builtin ("__MDROTLI", uw2_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MDROTLI);
8550 def_builtin ("__MCPLHI", uw1_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLHI);
8551 def_builtin ("__MCPLI", uw1_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLI);
8552 def_builtin ("__MDCUTSSI", uw2_ftype_acc_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MDCUTSSI);
8553 def_builtin ("__MQSATHS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSATHS);
8554 def_builtin ("__MHSETLOS", sw1_ftype_sw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOS);
8555 def_builtin ("__MHSETHIS", sw1_ftype_sw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIS);
8556 def_builtin ("__MHDSETS", sw1_ftype_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETS);
8557 def_builtin ("__MHSETLOH", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOH);
8558 def_builtin ("__MHSETHIH", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIH);
8559 def_builtin ("__MHDSETH", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETH);
8560 def_builtin ("__MQLCLRHS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQLCLRHS);
8561 def_builtin ("__MQLMTHS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQLMTHS);
8562 def_builtin ("__MQSLLHI", uw2_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSLLHI);
8563 def_builtin ("__MQSRAHI", sw2_ftype_sw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSRAHI);
8564 def_builtin ("__SMUL", sw2_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMUL);
8565 def_builtin ("__UMUL", uw2_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_UMUL);
8566 def_builtin ("__SMASS", void_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMASS);
8567 def_builtin ("__SMSSS", void_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMSSS);
8568 def_builtin ("__SMU", void_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMU);
8569 def_builtin ("__ADDSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_ADDSS);
8570 def_builtin ("__SUBSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SUBSS);
8571 def_builtin ("__SLASS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SLASS);
8572 def_builtin ("__SCAN", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SCAN);
8573 def_builtin ("__SCUTSS", sw1_ftype_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SCUTSS);
8574 def_builtin ("__IACCreadll", sw2_ftype_iacc, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadll);
8575 def_builtin ("__IACCreadl", sw1_ftype_iacc, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadl);
8576 def_builtin ("__IACCsetll", void_ftype_iacc_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetll);
8577 def_builtin ("__IACCsetl", void_ftype_iacc_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetl);
8578 def_builtin ("__data_prefetch0", void_ftype_ptr, FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH0);
8579 def_builtin ("__data_prefetch", void_ftype_ptr, FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH);
8580 def_builtin ("__builtin_read8", uw1_ftype_vptr, FRV_BUILTIN_READ8);
8581 def_builtin ("__builtin_read16", uw1_ftype_vptr, FRV_BUILTIN_READ16);
8582 def_builtin ("__builtin_read32", uw1_ftype_vptr, FRV_BUILTIN_READ32);
8583 def_builtin ("__builtin_read64", uw2_ftype_vptr, FRV_BUILTIN_READ64);
8585 def_builtin ("__builtin_write8", void_ftype_vptr_ub, FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE8);
8586 def_builtin ("__builtin_write16", void_ftype_vptr_uh, FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE16);
8587 def_builtin ("__builtin_write32", void_ftype_vptr_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE32);
8588 def_builtin ("__builtin_write64", void_ftype_vptr_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_WRITE64);
8590 #undef UNARY
8591 #undef BINARY
8592 #undef TRINARY
8593 #undef QUAD
8596 /* Set the names for various arithmetic operations according to the
8597 FRV ABI. */
8598 static void
8599 frv_init_libfuncs (void)
8601 set_optab_libfunc (smod_optab, SImode, "__modi");
8602 set_optab_libfunc (umod_optab, SImode, "__umodi");
8604 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, DImode, "__addll");
8605 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, DImode, "__subll");
8606 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, DImode, "__mulll");
8607 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, DImode, "__divll");
8608 set_optab_libfunc (smod_optab, DImode, "__modll");
8609 set_optab_libfunc (umod_optab, DImode, "__umodll");
8610 set_optab_libfunc (and_optab, DImode, "__andll");
8611 set_optab_libfunc (ior_optab, DImode, "__orll");
8612 set_optab_libfunc (xor_optab, DImode, "__xorll");
8613 set_optab_libfunc (one_cmpl_optab, DImode, "__notll");
8615 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, SFmode, "__addf");
8616 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, SFmode, "__subf");
8617 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, SFmode, "__mulf");
8618 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, SFmode, "__divf");
8620 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, DFmode, "__addd");
8621 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, DFmode, "__subd");
8622 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, DFmode, "__muld");
8623 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, DFmode, "__divd");
8625 set_conv_libfunc (sext_optab, DFmode, SFmode, "__ftod");
8626 set_conv_libfunc (trunc_optab, SFmode, DFmode, "__dtof");
8628 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, SImode, SFmode, "__ftoi");
8629 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, DImode, SFmode, "__ftoll");
8630 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, SImode, DFmode, "__dtoi");
8631 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, DImode, DFmode, "__dtoll");
8633 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, SImode, SFmode, "__ftoui");
8634 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, DImode, SFmode, "__ftoull");
8635 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, SImode, DFmode, "__dtoui");
8636 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, DImode, DFmode, "__dtoull");
8638 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, SFmode, SImode, "__itof");
8639 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, SFmode, DImode, "__lltof");
8640 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, DFmode, SImode, "__itod");
8641 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, DFmode, DImode, "__lltod");
8644 /* Convert an integer constant to an accumulator register. ICODE is the
8645 code of the target instruction, OPNUM is the number of the
8646 accumulator operand and OPVAL is the constant integer. Try both
8647 ACC and ACCG registers; only report an error if neither fit the
8648 instruction. */
8650 static rtx
8651 frv_int_to_acc (enum insn_code icode, int opnum, rtx opval)
8653 rtx reg;
8654 int i;
8656 /* ACCs and ACCGs are implicit global registers if media intrinsics
8657 are being used. We set up this lazily to avoid creating lots of
8658 unnecessary call_insn rtl in non-media code. */
8659 for (i = 0; i <= ACC_MASK; i++)
8660 if ((i & ACC_MASK) == i)
8661 global_regs[i + ACC_FIRST] = global_regs[i + ACCG_FIRST] = 1;
8663 if (GET_CODE (opval) != CONST_INT)
8665 error ("accumulator is not a constant integer");
8666 return NULL_RTX;
8668 if ((INTVAL (opval) & ~ACC_MASK) != 0)
8670 error ("accumulator number is out of bounds");
8671 return NULL_RTX;
8674 reg = gen_rtx_REG (insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].mode,
8675 ACC_FIRST + INTVAL (opval));
8676 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (reg, VOIDmode))
8677 SET_REGNO (reg, ACCG_FIRST + INTVAL (opval));
8679 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (reg, VOIDmode))
8681 error ("inappropriate accumulator for %qs", insn_data[icode].name);
8682 return NULL_RTX;
8684 return reg;
8687 /* If an ACC rtx has mode MODE, return the mode that the matching ACCG
8688 should have. */
8690 static enum machine_mode
8691 frv_matching_accg_mode (enum machine_mode mode)
8693 switch (mode)
8695 case V4SImode:
8696 return V4QImode;
8698 case DImode:
8699 return HImode;
8701 case SImode:
8702 return QImode;
8704 default:
8705 gcc_unreachable ();
8709 /* Given that a __builtin_read or __builtin_write function is accessing
8710 address ADDRESS, return the value that should be used as operand 1
8711 of the membar. */
8713 static rtx
8714 frv_io_address_cookie (rtx address)
8716 return (GET_CODE (address) == CONST_INT
8717 ? GEN_INT (INTVAL (address) / 8 * 8)
8718 : const0_rtx);
8721 /* Return the accumulator guard that should be paired with accumulator
8722 register ACC. The mode of the returned register is in the same
8723 class as ACC, but is four times smaller. */
8726 frv_matching_accg_for_acc (rtx acc)
8728 return gen_rtx_REG (frv_matching_accg_mode (GET_MODE (acc)),
8729 REGNO (acc) - ACC_FIRST + ACCG_FIRST);
8732 /* Read the requested argument from the call EXP given by INDEX.
8733 Return the value as an rtx. */
8735 static rtx
8736 frv_read_argument (tree exp, unsigned int index)
8738 return expand_normal (CALL_EXPR_ARG (exp, index));
8741 /* Like frv_read_argument, but interpret the argument as the number
8742 of an IACC register and return a (reg:MODE ...) rtx for it. */
8744 static rtx
8745 frv_read_iacc_argument (enum machine_mode mode, tree call,
8746 unsigned int index)
8748 int i, regno;
8749 rtx op;
8751 op = frv_read_argument (call, index);
8752 if (GET_CODE (op) != CONST_INT
8753 || INTVAL (op) < 0
8754 || INTVAL (op) > IACC_LAST - IACC_FIRST
8755 || ((INTVAL (op) * 4) & (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1)) != 0)
8757 error ("invalid IACC argument");
8758 op = const0_rtx;
8761 /* IACCs are implicit global registers. We set up this lazily to
8762 avoid creating lots of unnecessary call_insn rtl when IACCs aren't
8763 being used. */
8764 regno = INTVAL (op) + IACC_FIRST;
8765 for (i = 0; i < HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode); i++)
8766 global_regs[regno + i] = 1;
8768 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, regno);
8771 /* Return true if OPVAL can be used for operand OPNUM of instruction ICODE.
8772 The instruction should require a constant operand of some sort. The
8773 function prints an error if OPVAL is not valid. */
8775 static int
8776 frv_check_constant_argument (enum insn_code icode, int opnum, rtx opval)
8778 if (GET_CODE (opval) != CONST_INT)
8780 error ("%qs expects a constant argument", insn_data[icode].name);
8781 return FALSE;
8783 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (opval, VOIDmode))
8785 error ("constant argument out of range for %qs", insn_data[icode].name);
8786 return FALSE;
8788 return TRUE;
8791 /* Return a legitimate rtx for instruction ICODE's return value. Use TARGET
8792 if it's not null, has the right mode, and satisfies operand 0's
8793 predicate. */
8795 static rtx
8796 frv_legitimize_target (enum insn_code icode, rtx target)
8798 enum machine_mode mode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
8800 if (! target
8801 || GET_MODE (target) != mode
8802 || ! (*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (target, mode))
8803 return gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8804 else
8805 return target;
8808 /* Given that ARG is being passed as operand OPNUM to instruction ICODE,
8809 check whether ARG satisfies the operand's constraints. If it doesn't,
8810 copy ARG to a temporary register and return that. Otherwise return ARG
8811 itself. */
8813 static rtx
8814 frv_legitimize_argument (enum insn_code icode, int opnum, rtx arg)
8816 enum machine_mode mode = insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].mode;
8818 if ((*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (arg, mode))
8819 return arg;
8820 else
8821 return copy_to_mode_reg (mode, arg);
8824 /* Return a volatile memory reference of mode MODE whose address is ARG. */
8826 static rtx
8827 frv_volatile_memref (enum machine_mode mode, rtx arg)
8829 rtx mem;
8831 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, memory_address (mode, arg));
8832 MEM_VOLATILE_P (mem) = 1;
8833 return mem;
8836 /* Expand builtins that take a single, constant argument. At the moment,
8837 only MHDSETS falls into this category. */
8839 static rtx
8840 frv_expand_set_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call, rtx target)
8842 rtx pat;
8843 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8845 if (! frv_check_constant_argument (icode, 1, op0))
8846 return NULL_RTX;
8848 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8849 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0);
8850 if (! pat)
8851 return NULL_RTX;
8853 emit_insn (pat);
8854 return target;
8857 /* Expand builtins that take one operand. */
8859 static rtx
8860 frv_expand_unop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call, rtx target)
8862 rtx pat;
8863 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8865 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8866 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
8867 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0);
8868 if (! pat)
8869 return NULL_RTX;
8871 emit_insn (pat);
8872 return target;
8875 /* Expand builtins that take two operands. */
8877 static rtx
8878 frv_expand_binop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call, rtx target)
8880 rtx pat;
8881 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8882 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
8884 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8885 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
8886 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 2, op1);
8887 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1);
8888 if (! pat)
8889 return NULL_RTX;
8891 emit_insn (pat);
8892 return target;
8895 /* Expand cut-style builtins, which take two operands and an implicit ACCG
8896 one. */
8898 static rtx
8899 frv_expand_cut_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call, rtx target)
8901 rtx pat;
8902 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8903 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
8904 rtx op2;
8906 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8907 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 1, op0);
8908 if (! op0)
8909 return NULL_RTX;
8911 if (icode == CODE_FOR_mdcutssi || GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
8913 if (! frv_check_constant_argument (icode, 2, op1))
8914 return NULL_RTX;
8916 else
8917 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 2, op1);
8919 op2 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op0);
8920 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1, op2);
8921 if (! pat)
8922 return NULL_RTX;
8924 emit_insn (pat);
8925 return target;
8928 /* Expand builtins that take two operands and the second is immediate. */
8930 static rtx
8931 frv_expand_binopimm_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call, rtx target)
8933 rtx pat;
8934 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8935 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
8937 if (! frv_check_constant_argument (icode, 2, op1))
8938 return NULL_RTX;
8940 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8941 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
8942 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1);
8943 if (! pat)
8944 return NULL_RTX;
8946 emit_insn (pat);
8947 return target;
8950 /* Expand builtins that take two operands, the first operand being a pointer to
8951 ints and return void. */
8953 static rtx
8954 frv_expand_voidbinop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
8956 rtx pat;
8957 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8958 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
8959 enum machine_mode mode0 = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
8960 rtx addr;
8962 if (GET_CODE (op0) != MEM)
8964 rtx reg = op0;
8966 if (! offsettable_address_p (0, mode0, op0))
8968 reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
8969 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, op0));
8972 op0 = gen_rtx_MEM (SImode, reg);
8975 addr = XEXP (op0, 0);
8976 if (! offsettable_address_p (0, mode0, addr))
8977 addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, op0);
8979 op0 = change_address (op0, V4SImode, addr);
8980 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
8981 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1);
8982 if (! pat)
8983 return 0;
8985 emit_insn (pat);
8986 return 0;
8989 /* Expand builtins that take two long operands and return void. */
8991 static rtx
8992 frv_expand_int_void2arg (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
8994 rtx pat;
8995 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
8996 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
8998 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
8999 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
9000 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1);
9001 if (! pat)
9002 return NULL_RTX;
9004 emit_insn (pat);
9005 return NULL_RTX;
9008 /* Expand prefetch builtins. These take a single address as argument. */
9010 static rtx
9011 frv_expand_prefetches (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
9013 rtx pat;
9014 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9016 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (force_reg (Pmode, op0));
9017 if (! pat)
9018 return 0;
9020 emit_insn (pat);
9021 return 0;
9024 /* Expand builtins that take three operands and return void. The first
9025 argument must be a constant that describes a pair or quad accumulators. A
9026 fourth argument is created that is the accumulator guard register that
9027 corresponds to the accumulator. */
9029 static rtx
9030 frv_expand_voidtriop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
9032 rtx pat;
9033 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9034 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
9035 rtx op2 = frv_read_argument (call, 2);
9036 rtx op3;
9038 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
9039 if (! op0)
9040 return NULL_RTX;
9042 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
9043 op2 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 2, op2);
9044 op3 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op0);
9045 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1, op2, op3);
9046 if (! pat)
9047 return NULL_RTX;
9049 emit_insn (pat);
9050 return NULL_RTX;
9053 /* Expand builtins that perform accumulator-to-accumulator operations.
9054 These builtins take two accumulator numbers as argument and return
9055 void. */
9057 static rtx
9058 frv_expand_voidaccop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
9060 rtx pat;
9061 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9062 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
9063 rtx op2;
9064 rtx op3;
9066 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
9067 if (! op0)
9068 return NULL_RTX;
9070 op1 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 1, op1);
9071 if (! op1)
9072 return NULL_RTX;
9074 op2 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op0);
9075 op3 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op1);
9076 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1, op2, op3);
9077 if (! pat)
9078 return NULL_RTX;
9080 emit_insn (pat);
9081 return NULL_RTX;
9084 /* Expand a __builtin_read* function. ICODE is the instruction code for the
9085 membar and TARGET_MODE is the mode that the loaded value should have. */
9087 static rtx
9088 frv_expand_load_builtin (enum insn_code icode, enum machine_mode target_mode,
9089 tree call, rtx target)
9091 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9092 rtx cookie = frv_io_address_cookie (op0);
9094 if (target == 0 || !REG_P (target))
9095 target = gen_reg_rtx (target_mode);
9096 op0 = frv_volatile_memref (insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode, op0);
9097 convert_move (target, op0, 1);
9098 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (copy_rtx (op0), cookie, GEN_INT (FRV_IO_READ)));
9099 cfun->machine->has_membar_p = 1;
9100 return target;
9103 /* Likewise __builtin_write* functions. */
9105 static rtx
9106 frv_expand_store_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
9108 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9109 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
9110 rtx cookie = frv_io_address_cookie (op0);
9112 op0 = frv_volatile_memref (insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode, op0);
9113 convert_move (op0, force_reg (insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode, op1), 1);
9114 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (copy_rtx (op0), cookie, GEN_INT (FRV_IO_WRITE)));
9115 cfun->machine->has_membar_p = 1;
9116 return NULL_RTX;
9119 /* Expand the MDPACKH builtin. It takes four unsigned short arguments and
9120 each argument forms one word of the two double-word input registers.
9121 CALL is the tree for the call and TARGET, if nonnull, suggests a good place
9122 to put the return value. */
9124 static rtx
9125 frv_expand_mdpackh_builtin (tree call, rtx target)
9127 enum insn_code icode = CODE_FOR_mdpackh;
9128 rtx pat, op0, op1;
9129 rtx arg1 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9130 rtx arg2 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
9131 rtx arg3 = frv_read_argument (call, 2);
9132 rtx arg4 = frv_read_argument (call, 3);
9134 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
9135 op0 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
9136 op1 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
9138 /* The high half of each word is not explicitly initialized, so indicate
9139 that the input operands are not live before this point. */
9140 emit_clobber (op0);
9141 emit_clobber (op1);
9143 /* Move each argument into the low half of its associated input word. */
9144 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op0, DImode, 2), arg1);
9145 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op0, DImode, 6), arg2);
9146 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op1, DImode, 2), arg3);
9147 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op1, DImode, 6), arg4);
9149 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1);
9150 if (! pat)
9151 return NULL_RTX;
9153 emit_insn (pat);
9154 return target;
9157 /* Expand the MCLRACC builtin. This builtin takes a single accumulator
9158 number as argument. */
9160 static rtx
9161 frv_expand_mclracc_builtin (tree call)
9163 enum insn_code icode = CODE_FOR_mclracc;
9164 rtx pat;
9165 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9167 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
9168 if (! op0)
9169 return NULL_RTX;
9171 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0);
9172 if (pat)
9173 emit_insn (pat);
9175 return NULL_RTX;
9178 /* Expand builtins that take no arguments. */
9180 static rtx
9181 frv_expand_noargs_builtin (enum insn_code icode)
9183 rtx pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (const0_rtx);
9184 if (pat)
9185 emit_insn (pat);
9187 return NULL_RTX;
9190 /* Expand MRDACC and MRDACCG. These builtins take a single accumulator
9191 number or accumulator guard number as argument and return an SI integer. */
9193 static rtx
9194 frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
9196 rtx pat;
9197 rtx target = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
9198 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9200 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 1, op0);
9201 if (! op0)
9202 return NULL_RTX;
9204 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0);
9205 if (! pat)
9206 return NULL_RTX;
9208 emit_insn (pat);
9209 return target;
9212 /* Expand MWTACC and MWTACCG. These builtins take an accumulator or
9213 accumulator guard as their first argument and an SImode value as their
9214 second. */
9216 static rtx
9217 frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree call)
9219 rtx pat;
9220 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (call, 0);
9221 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (call, 1);
9223 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
9224 if (! op0)
9225 return NULL_RTX;
9227 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
9228 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1);
9229 if (pat)
9230 emit_insn (pat);
9232 return NULL_RTX;
9235 /* Emit a move from SRC to DEST in SImode chunks. This can be used
9236 to move DImode values into and out of IACC0. */
9238 static void
9239 frv_split_iacc_move (rtx dest, rtx src)
9241 enum machine_mode inner;
9242 int i;
9244 inner = GET_MODE (dest);
9245 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (inner); i += GET_MODE_SIZE (SImode))
9246 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (SImode, dest, inner, i),
9247 simplify_gen_subreg (SImode, src, inner, i));
9250 /* Expand builtins. */
9252 static rtx
9253 frv_expand_builtin (tree exp,
9254 rtx target,
9255 rtx subtarget ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9256 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9257 int ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9259 tree fndecl = TREE_OPERAND (CALL_EXPR_FN (exp), 0);
9260 unsigned fcode = (unsigned)DECL_FUNCTION_CODE (fndecl);
9261 unsigned i;
9262 struct builtin_description *d;
9264 if (fcode < FRV_BUILTIN_FIRST_NONMEDIA && !TARGET_MEDIA)
9266 error ("media functions are not available unless -mmedia is used");
9267 return NULL_RTX;
9270 switch (fcode)
9272 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP1:
9273 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP2:
9274 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDUNPACKH:
9275 case FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOHE:
9276 if (! TARGET_MEDIA_REV1)
9278 error ("this media function is only available on the fr500");
9279 return NULL_RTX;
9281 break;
9283 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACHS:
9284 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACXHS:
9285 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACXHS:
9286 case FRV_BUILTIN_MADDACCS:
9287 case FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBACCS:
9288 case FRV_BUILTIN_MASACCS:
9289 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDADDACCS:
9290 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDSUBACCS:
9291 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDASACCS:
9292 case FRV_BUILTIN_MABSHS:
9293 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDROTLI:
9294 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLHI:
9295 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLI:
9296 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDCUTSSI:
9297 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQSATHS:
9298 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOS:
9299 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOH:
9300 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIS:
9301 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIH:
9302 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETS:
9303 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETH:
9304 if (! TARGET_MEDIA_REV2)
9306 error ("this media function is only available on the fr400"
9307 " and fr550");
9308 return NULL_RTX;
9310 break;
9312 case FRV_BUILTIN_SMASS:
9313 case FRV_BUILTIN_SMSSS:
9314 case FRV_BUILTIN_SMU:
9315 case FRV_BUILTIN_ADDSS:
9316 case FRV_BUILTIN_SUBSS:
9317 case FRV_BUILTIN_SLASS:
9318 case FRV_BUILTIN_SCUTSS:
9319 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadll:
9320 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadl:
9321 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetll:
9322 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetl:
9323 if (!TARGET_FR405_BUILTINS)
9325 error ("this builtin function is only available"
9326 " on the fr405 and fr450");
9327 return NULL_RTX;
9329 break;
9331 case FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH:
9332 if (!TARGET_FR500_FR550_BUILTINS)
9334 error ("this builtin function is only available on the fr500"
9335 " and fr550");
9336 return NULL_RTX;
9338 break;
9340 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQLCLRHS:
9341 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQLMTHS:
9342 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQSLLHI:
9343 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQSRAHI:
9344 if (!TARGET_MEDIA_FR450)
9346 error ("this builtin function is only available on the fr450");
9347 return NULL_RTX;
9349 break;
9351 default:
9352 break;
9355 /* Expand unique builtins. */
9357 switch (fcode)
9359 case FRV_BUILTIN_MTRAP:
9360 return frv_expand_noargs_builtin (CODE_FOR_mtrap);
9362 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACC:
9363 return frv_expand_mclracc_builtin (exp);
9365 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACCA:
9366 if (TARGET_ACC_8)
9367 return frv_expand_noargs_builtin (CODE_FOR_mclracca8);
9368 else
9369 return frv_expand_noargs_builtin (CODE_FOR_mclracca4);
9371 case FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACC:
9372 return frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mrdacc, exp);
9374 case FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACCG:
9375 return frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mrdaccg, exp);
9377 case FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACC:
9378 return frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mwtacc, exp);
9380 case FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACCG:
9381 return frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mwtaccg, exp);
9383 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDPACKH:
9384 return frv_expand_mdpackh_builtin (exp, target);
9386 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadll:
9388 rtx src = frv_read_iacc_argument (DImode, exp, 0);
9389 if (target == 0 || !REG_P (target))
9390 target = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
9391 frv_split_iacc_move (target, src);
9392 return target;
9395 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadl:
9396 return frv_read_iacc_argument (SImode, exp, 0);
9398 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetll:
9400 rtx dest = frv_read_iacc_argument (DImode, exp, 0);
9401 rtx src = frv_read_argument (exp, 1);
9402 frv_split_iacc_move (dest, force_reg (DImode, src));
9403 return 0;
9406 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetl:
9408 rtx dest = frv_read_iacc_argument (SImode, exp, 0);
9409 rtx src = frv_read_argument (exp, 1);
9410 emit_move_insn (dest, force_reg (SImode, src));
9411 return 0;
9414 default:
9415 break;
9418 /* Expand groups of builtins. */
9420 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_set; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_set); i++, d++)
9421 if (d->code == fcode)
9422 return frv_expand_set_builtin (d->icode, exp, target);
9424 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_1arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_1arg); i++, d++)
9425 if (d->code == fcode)
9426 return frv_expand_unop_builtin (d->icode, exp, target);
9428 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_2arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_2arg); i++, d++)
9429 if (d->code == fcode)
9430 return frv_expand_binop_builtin (d->icode, exp, target);
9432 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_cut; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_cut); i++, d++)
9433 if (d->code == fcode)
9434 return frv_expand_cut_builtin (d->icode, exp, target);
9436 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_2argimm; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_2argimm); i++, d++)
9437 if (d->code == fcode)
9438 return frv_expand_binopimm_builtin (d->icode, exp, target);
9440 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_void2arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_void2arg); i++, d++)
9441 if (d->code == fcode)
9442 return frv_expand_voidbinop_builtin (d->icode, exp);
9444 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_void3arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_void3arg); i++, d++)
9445 if (d->code == fcode)
9446 return frv_expand_voidtriop_builtin (d->icode, exp);
9448 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_voidacc; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_voidacc); i++, d++)
9449 if (d->code == fcode)
9450 return frv_expand_voidaccop_builtin (d->icode, exp);
9452 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_int_void2arg;
9453 i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_int_void2arg); i++, d++)
9454 if (d->code == fcode)
9455 return frv_expand_int_void2arg (d->icode, exp);
9457 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_prefetches;
9458 i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_prefetches); i++, d++)
9459 if (d->code == fcode)
9460 return frv_expand_prefetches (d->icode, exp);
9462 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_loads; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_loads); i++, d++)
9463 if (d->code == fcode)
9464 return frv_expand_load_builtin (d->icode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9465 exp, target);
9467 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_stores; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_stores); i++, d++)
9468 if (d->code == fcode)
9469 return frv_expand_store_builtin (d->icode, exp);
9471 return 0;
9474 static bool
9475 frv_in_small_data_p (const_tree decl)
9477 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
9478 const char *section_name;
9480 /* Don't apply the -G flag to internal compiler structures. We
9481 should leave such structures in the main data section, partly
9482 for efficiency and partly because the size of some of them
9483 (such as C++ typeinfos) is not known until later. */
9484 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
9485 return false;
9487 /* If we already know which section the decl should be in, see if
9488 it's a small data section. */
9489 section_name = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
9490 if (section_name)
9492 if (frv_string_begins_with (section_name, ".sdata"))
9493 return true;
9494 if (frv_string_begins_with (section_name, ".sbss"))
9495 return true;
9496 return false;
9499 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl));
9500 if (size > 0 && size <= g_switch_value)
9501 return true;
9503 return false;
9506 static bool
9507 frv_rtx_costs (rtx x,
9508 int code ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9509 int outer_code ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9510 int opno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9511 int *total,
9512 bool speed ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9514 if (outer_code == MEM)
9516 /* Don't differentiate between memory addresses. All the ones
9517 we accept have equal cost. */
9518 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (0);
9519 return true;
9522 switch (code)
9524 case CONST_INT:
9525 /* Make 12-bit integers really cheap. */
9526 if (IN_RANGE (INTVAL (x), -2048, 2047))
9528 *total = 0;
9529 return true;
9531 /* Fall through. */
9533 case CONST:
9534 case LABEL_REF:
9535 case SYMBOL_REF:
9536 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9537 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
9538 return true;
9540 case PLUS:
9541 case MINUS:
9542 case AND:
9543 case IOR:
9544 case XOR:
9545 case ASHIFT:
9546 case ASHIFTRT:
9547 case LSHIFTRT:
9548 case NOT:
9549 case NEG:
9550 case COMPARE:
9551 if (GET_MODE (x) == SImode)
9552 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
9553 else if (GET_MODE (x) == DImode)
9554 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
9555 else
9556 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3);
9557 return true;
9559 case MULT:
9560 if (GET_MODE (x) == SImode)
9561 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
9562 else
9563 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (6); /* guess */
9564 return true;
9566 case DIV:
9567 case UDIV:
9568 case MOD:
9569 case UMOD:
9570 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (18);
9571 return true;
9573 case MEM:
9574 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3);
9575 return true;
9577 default:
9578 return false;
9582 static void
9583 frv_asm_out_constructor (rtx symbol, int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9585 switch_to_section (ctors_section);
9586 assemble_align (POINTER_SIZE);
9587 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
9589 int ok = frv_assemble_integer (symbol, POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT, 1);
9591 gcc_assert (ok);
9592 return;
9594 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.picptr\t", symbol);
9597 static void
9598 frv_asm_out_destructor (rtx symbol, int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9600 switch_to_section (dtors_section);
9601 assemble_align (POINTER_SIZE);
9602 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
9604 int ok = frv_assemble_integer (symbol, POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT, 1);
9606 gcc_assert (ok);
9607 return;
9609 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.picptr\t", symbol);
9612 /* Worker function for TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX. */
9614 static rtx
9615 frv_struct_value_rtx (tree fntype ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9616 int incoming ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9618 return gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM);
9621 #define TLS_BIAS (2048 - 16)
9623 /* This is called from dwarf2out.c via TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL.
9624 We need to emit DTP-relative relocations. */
9626 static void
9627 frv_output_dwarf_dtprel (FILE *file, int size, rtx x)
9629 gcc_assert (size == 4);
9630 fputs ("\t.picptr\ttlsmoff(", file);
9631 /* We want the unbiased TLS offset, so add the bias to the
9632 expression, such that the implicit biasing cancels out. */
9633 output_addr_const (file, plus_constant (Pmode, x, TLS_BIAS));
9634 fputs (")", file);
9637 #include "gt-frv.h"